blob: 0242edf39ecc7ea11becee360858c316d8244b1c [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1f973062021-05-14 09:36:37 +02005 version 2.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau4b3a9fe2021-09-12 11:36:38 +02007 2021/09/12
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001028.2.4. HTTPS log format
1038.2.5. Custom log format
1048.2.6. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001058.3. Advanced logging options
1068.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1078.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1098.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1108.4. Timing events
1118.5. Session state at disconnection
1128.6. Non-printable characters
1138.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1148.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1158.9. Examples of logs
116
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001179. Supported filters
1189.1. Trace
1199.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001209.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001219.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001229.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001239.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012510. FastCGI applications
12610.1. Setup
12710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12810.1.2. Proxy section
12910.1.3. Example
13010.2. Default parameters
13110.3. Limitations
132
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013311. Address formats
13411.1. Address family prefixes
13511.2. Socket type prefixes
13611.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
1381. Quick reminder about HTTP
139----------------------------
140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
143on almost anything found in the contents.
144
145However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
146formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
147correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
148
149
1501.1. The HTTP transaction model
151-------------------------------
152
153The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100154to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100155from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
156connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157will involve a new connection :
158
159 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
160
161In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
162establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
163by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
164length.
165
166Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
167to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
168however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
169response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
170header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
171
172 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
173
174Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
175power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
176but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200177a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100179Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
181second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
182page :
183
184 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
185
186This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
187latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
188correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
189the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100190server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
193time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
194are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
195parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
196carry the stream identifier.
197
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
199connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
200leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100201start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
202processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
203waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200204
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200205HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100206 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
207 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100208 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200210 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100211
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213
2141.2. HTTP request
215-----------------
216
217First, let's consider this HTTP request :
218
219 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100220 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
222 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
223 3 User-agent: my small browser
224 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
225 5 Accept: image/png
226
227
2281.2.1. The Request line
229-----------------------
230
231Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
232
233 - a METHOD : GET
234 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
236
237All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
238which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
239followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
240is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
241desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
242the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
243
244The URI itself can have several forms :
245
246 - A "relative URI" :
247
248 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
251 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
252
253 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
254
255 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
256
257 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
258 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
259 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
260 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
261 must accept this form too.
262
263 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
264 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
265 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200267 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
268 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
269 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
270 other protocols too.
271
272In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
273mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
274on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
275It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
276specific to the language, framework or application in use.
277
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100279assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200297as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
298normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
299representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
300HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301
302The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
303that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
304is one valid form of empty line.
305
306Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
307headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
308about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
309application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
310
311Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000312 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
314 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
315 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
316
317
3181.3. HTTP response
319------------------
320
321An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
322messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
323
324 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100325 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
327 2 Content-length: 350
328 3 Content-Type: text/html
329
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
331codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
332response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100333continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
334the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
335following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
336sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
337(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
338correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
339such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
340state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400341over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100342if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
343information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003461.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347------------------------
348
349Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
350
351 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
352 - a status code : 200
353 - a reason : OK
354
355The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100356 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
357 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
358 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
359 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
360 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000362Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100363"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
365messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
366or "Authentication Required".
367
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100368HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369
370 Code When / reason
371 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
372 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100375 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
376 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 400 for an invalid or too large request
378 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
379 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100381 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100383 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
384 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400387 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100388 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200390 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200391 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
392 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
393 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
394
395The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3964.2).
397
398
3991.3.2. The response headers
400---------------------------
401
402Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
403the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
404details.
405
406
4072. Configuring HAProxy
408----------------------
409
4102.1. Configuration file format
411------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200412
413HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
414
415 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700417 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200419
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100420The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
421a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100422
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100423 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
424
425 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
426
427 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
428 tab characters
429
430 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
431 keyword sequences listed in this document
432
433 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
434 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
435 parts of the configuration, or expressions
436
437 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
438 are supported
439
440 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
441 section
442
443This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
444generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
445figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
446
447First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
448the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
449a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
450word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
451follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
452the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
453the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
454the parts that need to be addressed.
455
456A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
457requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
458extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
459the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
460section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
461section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
462not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
463
464A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
465each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
466a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
467start a new one.
468
469Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
470that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
471applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
472"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
473processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
474ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
475which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
476In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
477of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
478identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
479such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4802, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
481
482 listen foo
483 bind :80
484
485 listen bar
486 bind :81
487
488Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
489spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
490of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
491following configurations are strictly equivalent:
492
493 global#this is the global section
494 daemon#daemonize
495 frontend foo
496 mode http # or tcp
497
498and:
499
500 global
501 daemon
502
503 # this is the public web frontend
504 frontend foo
505 mode http
506
507The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
508new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
509other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
510section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
511section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
512at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
513
514Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
515are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
516editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
517support automatic indent.
518
519In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
520positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
521modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
522anymore, and is not recommended.
523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200524
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005252.2. Quoting and escaping
526-------------------------
527
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100528In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
529that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
530possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
531in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
532('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200533
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100534This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
535very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
536the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
537also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
538delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
539word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
540remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200541
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100542If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
543(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
544
545Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
546backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200547
548 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
549 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
550 \\ to use a backslash
551 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
552 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
553
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100554In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
555C-language representation:
556
557 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
558 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
559 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
560 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
561
562Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
563or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
564of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200567 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
568 # hash as a comment start
569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
571evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
572dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
573backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200574
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100575Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
576character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
577is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200578
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100579As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
580entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
581name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
582represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
583hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200584
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100585 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
586 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
587 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
588 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
589 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
590 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
591 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
592 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
593 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
594 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
595 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200596
597 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100598 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200599 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
601 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
603 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
604
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100605There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
606necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
607by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
608they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
609escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
610characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
611case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
612if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
613own quotes.
614
615The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
616quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500617not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100618quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
619
620Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
621arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
622
623 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
624 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
625
626Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
627"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
628cannot write:
629
630 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
631
632because we would like the string to cut like this:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |---------|----|-|
636 arg1 _/ / /
637 arg2 __________/ /
638 arg3 ______________/
639
640but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
641parenthesis then garbage:
642
643 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
644 |--------|--------|
645 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
646 trailing garbage _________/
647
648The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
649quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
650processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
651this word:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
656
657So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
658still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
659the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
660the second level:
661
662 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
663 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
664 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
665 |---------||----|-|
666 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
667 arg2=blah ___________/ /
668 arg3=g _______________/
669
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500670Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100671double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
672
673 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
674 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
675 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
676 |---------||----|-|
677 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
678 arg2 ___________/ /
679 arg3 _______________/
680
681When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
682appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
683string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
684thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
685
686 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
687 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
688 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
689 |-------------| |-----||-|
690 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
691 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
692 arg3 ______________________/
693
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400694Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100695that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
696quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
697single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
698level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
699
700When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
701double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
702and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
703a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
704a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
705the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
706regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
707around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
708more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200709
710
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007112.3. Environment variables
712--------------------------
713
714HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
715interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
716configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
717optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
718shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200719underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
720list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
721arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
722before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200723
724 Example:
725
726 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
727
728 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
729
730 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
731
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200732Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
733file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200734
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200735* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
736 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
737
738* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
739 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
740 directory.
741
742* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
743
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500744* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200745 processes, separated by semicolons.
746
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500747* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200748 CLI, separated by semicolons.
749
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200750In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
751regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
752only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
753
754* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
755
756* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
757 starting at one.
758
759* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
760 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
761 first section.
762
763These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
764if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
765section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
766"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
767proxies.
768
769This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
770logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
771to name some config objects like servers for example.
772
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200773See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200774
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100775
7762.4. Conditional blocks
777-----------------------
778
779It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
780some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
781ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
782configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
783versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
784preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
785text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
786lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
787switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
788are defined to form conditional blocks:
789
790 - .if <condition>
791 - .elif <condition>
792 - .else
793 - .endif
794
795The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
796as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
797matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
798there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
799only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
800".elif" of a block.
801
802Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
803ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
804as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
805
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200806Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
807See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
808
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200809The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
810expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100811
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100812 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
813 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200814 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200815 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530816 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
817 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200818 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
819 from left to right until one returns false
820 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
821 from right to left until one returns true
822
823Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
824operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200825
826The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
827
828 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
829 exists, regardless of its contents
830
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200831 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
832 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
833 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
834
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200835 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
836 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
837
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200838 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
839 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
840 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
841 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
842
843 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
844 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
845 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
846 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
847
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200848Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100849
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200850 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
851 listen mwcli_px
852 bind :1111
853 ...
854 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100855
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200856 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
857 bind :80
858 .endif
859
860 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200861 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200862 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200863 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200864 .endif
865
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200866 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200867 bind :443 ssl crt ...
868 .endif
869
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200870 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
871 profiling.memory on
872 .endif
873
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200874 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
875 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
876 .endif
877
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200878Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100879
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200880 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100881 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
882 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
883 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
884
885Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
886"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
887fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
888provide advice to the user.
889
890Example:
891
892 .if "${A}"
893 .if "${B}"
894 .notice "A=1, B=1"
895 .elif "${C}"
896 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
897 .elif "${D}"
898 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
899 .else
900 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
901 .endif
902 .else
903 .notice "A=0"
904 .endif
905
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200906 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
907 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
908
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100909
9102.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200911----------------
912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100913Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100914values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
915otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
916numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
917for every keyword. Supported units are :
918
919 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
920 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
921 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
922 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
923 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
924 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
925
926
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009272.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200928-------------
929
930 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
931 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
932 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
933 global
934 daemon
935 maxconn 256
936
937 defaults
938 mode http
939 timeout connect 5000ms
940 timeout client 50000ms
941 timeout server 50000ms
942
943 frontend http-in
944 bind *:80
945 default_backend servers
946
947 backend servers
948 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
949
950
951 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
952 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
953 global
954 daemon
955 maxconn 256
956
957 defaults
958 mode http
959 timeout connect 5000ms
960 timeout client 50000ms
961 timeout server 50000ms
962
963 listen http-in
964 bind *:80
965 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
966
967
968Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
969
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100970 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200971
972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009733. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200974--------------------
975
976Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
977are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
978of them have command-line equivalents.
979
980The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
981
982 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200983 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200984 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200985 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200986 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200987 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200988 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200989 - description
990 - deviceatlas-json-file
991 - deviceatlas-log-level
992 - deviceatlas-separator
993 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200994 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900995 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200996 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +0200997 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200998 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100999 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001000 - h1-case-adjust
1001 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001002 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001003 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001004 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001005 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001006 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001007 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001008 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001009 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001010 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001011 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001012 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001013 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001014 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001015 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001016 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001017 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001018 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001019 - presetenv
1020 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001021 - uid
1022 - ulimit-n
1023 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001024 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001025 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001026 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001027 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001028 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001029 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001030 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001031 - ssl-default-bind-options
1032 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001033 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001034 - ssl-default-server-options
1035 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001036 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001037 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001038 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001039 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001040 - 51degrees-data-file
1041 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001042 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001043 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001044 - wurfl-data-file
1045 - wurfl-information-list
1046 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001047 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001048 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001049
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001050 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001051 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001052 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001053 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001054 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001055 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001056 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001057 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001058 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001059 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001060 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001061 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001062 - noepoll
1063 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001064 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001065 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001066 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001067 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001068 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001069 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001070 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001071 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001072 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001073 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001074 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001075 - tune.buffers.limit
1076 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001077 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001078 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001079 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001080 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001081 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001082 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001083 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001084 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001085 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001086 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001087 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001088 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001089 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001090 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1091 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001092 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001093 - tune.maxaccept
1094 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001095 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001096 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001097 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001098 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1099 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001100 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1101 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001102 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001103 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001104 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001105 - tune.sndbuf.client
1106 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001107 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001108 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001109 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001110 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001111 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001112 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001113 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02001114 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1115 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001116 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001117 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001118 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1119 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1120 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001121 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1122 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001123
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001124 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001125 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001126 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001127
1128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011293.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001130------------------------------------
1131
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001132ca-base <dir>
1133 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001134 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1135 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1136 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001137
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001138chroot <jail dir>
1139 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1140 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1141 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1142 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1143 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001144 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001145
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001146cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001147 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001148 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1149 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1150 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1151 set. These sets have the format
1152
1153 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1154
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001155 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
1156 word size. Any process IDs above 1 and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001157 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001158 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all thraeds at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001159 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1160 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001161 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1162 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1163 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1164 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1165 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1166 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1167 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1168 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1169 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1170 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001171
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001172 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1173 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1174 on the machine's word size.
1175
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001176 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001177 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing threads and
1178 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1179 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
1180 highest bound. Having both a process and a thread range with the "auto:"
1181 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1182 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001183
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001184 Note that process ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a
1185 lone number designates a process and must be 1, and specifying a thread range
1186 or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of it. Finally, "1" is strictly
1187 equivalent to "1/all" and designates all threads on the process.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001188
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001189 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001190 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1191 # first 4 CPUs
1192
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001193 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1194 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001195 # word size.
1196
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001197 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1198 # and so on.
1199 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1200 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1201 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1202
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001203 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1204 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1205 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1206 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001207
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001208 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1209 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1210 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001211
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001212crt-base <dir>
1213 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001214 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1215 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001216
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001217daemon
1218 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1219 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001220 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1221 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001222
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001223default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001224 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001225 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1226 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1227 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1228 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1229 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1230 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1231 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1232 not start with a slash ('/'):
1233 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1234 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1235
1236 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1237 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1238 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1239 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1240 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1241 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1242 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1243 each of them.
1244
1245 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1246 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1247 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1248 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1249 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1250 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1251 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1252 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1253
1254 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1255 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001256 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001257 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1258 made easily relocatable.
1259
1260 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1261 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1262 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1263 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1264 consistent across all configuration files.
1265
1266 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1267 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1268 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1269 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1270 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1271 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1272 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1273 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1274
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001275deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1276 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001277 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001278
1279deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001280 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001281 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1282
1283deviceatlas-separator <char>
1284 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1285 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1286
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001287deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001288 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1289 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1290 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001291
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001292expose-experimental-directives
1293 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1294 the config file will be rejected.
1295
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001296external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001297 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1298 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001299 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1300 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1301 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1302 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1303 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001304
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001305gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001306 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001307 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1308 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001309 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001310 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001311 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001312
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001313grace <time>
1314 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1315
1316 Arguments :
1317 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1318 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1319 soft-stop operation.
1320
1321 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1322 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1323 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1324 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1325 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1326 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1327 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1328 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1329 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1330
1331 Example:
1332
1333 global
1334 grace 10s
1335
1336 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1337 frontend ext-check
1338 bind :9999
1339 monitor-uri /ext-check
1340 monitor fail if { stopping }
1341
1342 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1343 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1344 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1345 SIGUSR1 signal.
1346
1347 Example:
1348
1349 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1350 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1351 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1352 frontend ext-check
1353 bind :9999
1354 monitor-uri /ext-check
1355 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1356
1357 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1358
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001359group <group name>
1360 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1361 See also "gid" and "user".
1362
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001363hard-stop-after <time>
1364 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1365
1366 Arguments :
1367 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1368 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1369 SIGUSR1 signal.
1370
1371 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1372 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1373 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1374
1375 Example:
1376 global
1377 hard-stop-after 30s
1378
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001379 See also: grace
1380
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001381h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1382 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1383 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1384 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1385 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001386 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001387 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1388 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1389 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1390 specified in a proxy.
1391
1392 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1393 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1394 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1395 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1396 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1397 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1398 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1399
1400 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1401 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1402 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1403 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1404 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1405
1406 Example:
1407 global
1408 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1409
1410 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1411 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1412
1413h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1414 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1415 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1416 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1417 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1418 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1419 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1420 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1421 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1422
1423 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1424 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1425 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1426
1427 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1428 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1429
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001430insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001431 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001432 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1433 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1434 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1435 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1436 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1437 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1438 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001439 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001440 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1441 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1442 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1443 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1444 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1445 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1446 disable it.
1447
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001448insecure-setuid-wanted
1449 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1450 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1451 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1452 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001453 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001454 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001455 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001456 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1457 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001458 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001459 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1460 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1461 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1462 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1463
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001464issuers-chain-path <dir>
1465 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1466 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1467 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001468 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001469 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1470 "issuers-chain-path".
1471 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1472 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1473 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1474 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1475 will share the chain in memory.
1476
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001477h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1478 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1479 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1480 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1481 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1482 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1483 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1484 the keyword with "no'.
1485
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001486localpeer <name>
1487 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1488 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1489 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1490 the configuration parsing.
1491
1492 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1493 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1494
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001495log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001496 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001497 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001498 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001499 configured with "log global".
1500
1501 <address> can be one of:
1502
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001503 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001504 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1505 port).
1506
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001507 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1508 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1509 port).
1510
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001511 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001512 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1513 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001514 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001515
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001516 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1517 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1518 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1519 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1520 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1521 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1522 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1523 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1524 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1525 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001526 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001527 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1528 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1529 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001530 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1531 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001532
1533 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1534 "fd@2", see above.
1535
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001536 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1537 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1538 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1539 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1540 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1541
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001542 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1543 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001544
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001545 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1546 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1547 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1548 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1549 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1550 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1551 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1552 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1553 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1554 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001555 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1556 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001557
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001558 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1559 one of the following :
1560
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001561 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1562 field is stripped. This is the default.
1563 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1564 rfc3164.
1565
1566 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001567 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1568
1569 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1570 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1571
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001572 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1573 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1574 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1575 designed to be used with a local log server.
1576
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001577 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1578 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1579 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1580 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1581 logger consumes.
1582
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001583 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1584 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1585 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1586 used with a local log server.
1587
1588 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1589 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1590 designed to be used with a local log server.
1591
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001592 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1593 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1594 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1595 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1596
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001597 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1598 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1599 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1600 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1601 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1602
1603 <sample_size>
1604 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1605 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1606 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1607 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1608 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1609
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001610 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001611
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001612 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1613 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1614 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1615
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001616 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1617 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1618 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1619 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001620
1621 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001622 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1623 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1624 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1625 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1626 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1627 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001628
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001629 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001630
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001631log-send-hostname [<string>]
1632 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1633 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1634 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1635 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1636 the logs.
1637
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001638log-tag <string>
1639 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1640 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1641 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001642 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001643
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001644lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001645 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1646 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1647 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1648 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1649 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1650 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001651 used multiple times.
1652
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001653lua-load-per-thread <file>
1654 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1655 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1656 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1657 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1658 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1659 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1660 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1661 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1662 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1663 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1664 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1665 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1666 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1667 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1668 times.
1669
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001670lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1671 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1672 variable.
1673 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1674 to "path".
1675
1676 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1677 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1678 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1679 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1680 will be checked earlier.
1681
1682 As an example by specifying the following path:
1683
1684 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1685 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1686
1687 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1688 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1689 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1690 paths if that does not exist either.
1691
1692 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1693 documentation.
1694
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001695master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001696 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1697 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1698 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001699 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001700 or daemon mode.
1701
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001702 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1703 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1704 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1705 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1706 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001707
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001708 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001709
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001710mworker-max-reloads <number>
1711 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001712 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001713 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1714 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1715 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1716
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001717nbthread <number>
1718 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001719 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1720 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1721 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1722 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1723 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1724 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1725 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001726
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001727numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001728 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001729 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1730 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1731 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1732 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1733 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1734 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1735 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1736 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1737
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001738pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001739 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1740 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1741 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1742 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001743
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001744pp2-never-send-local
1745 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1746 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1747 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1748 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1749 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1750 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1751 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1752 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1753 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1754 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1755 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1756
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001757presetenv <name> <value>
1758 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1759 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1760 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1761 and "unsetenv".
1762
1763resetenv [<name> ...]
1764 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1765 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1766 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1767 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1768 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1769 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1770 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1771 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1772
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001773stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001774 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some stats
1775 instances on certain processes only. The default and only accepted value is
1776 "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this setting.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001777
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001778server-state-base <directory>
1779 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001780 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1781 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001782
1783server-state-file <file>
1784 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1785 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1786 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1787 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1788 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1789 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1790 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1791 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001792 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1793 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001794
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001795set-var <var-name> <expr>
1796 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1797 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1798 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1799 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1800 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1801 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001802 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001803 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1804 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1805
1806 Example:
1807 global
1808 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1809 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1810 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1811
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001812set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
1813 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
1814 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1815 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1816 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
1817 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
1818 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
1819 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
1820 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
1821 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1822 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
1823
1824 Example:
1825 global
1826 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
1827 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
1828
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001829setenv <name> <value>
1830 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1831 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1832 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1833 and "unsetenv".
1834
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001835set-dumpable
1836 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001837 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1838 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1839 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1840 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1841 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1842 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1843 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1844 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1845 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1846 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1847 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1848 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1849 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1850 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1851 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001852 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001853 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001854
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001855ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1857 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001858 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001859 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001860 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1861 information and recommendations see e.g.
1862 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1863 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1864 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1865 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001866
1867ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1868 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1869 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1870 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1871 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1872 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001873 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1874 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1875 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001876 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001877
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001878ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1879 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1880 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1881 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1882 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1883 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1884
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001885ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1886 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1887 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1888 keyword to see available options.
1889
1890 Example:
1891 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001892 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001893
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001894ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1895 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1896 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001897 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001898 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001899 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1900 information and recommendations see e.g.
1901 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1902 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1903 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1904 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1905 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001906
1907ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1908 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1909 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1910 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1911 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1912 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001913 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1914 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1915 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1916 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001917
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001918ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1919 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1920 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1921 keyword to see available options.
1922
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001923ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1924 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1925 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1926 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001927 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001928 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001929 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1930 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1931 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1932 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001933 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1934 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1935 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1936
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001937ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1938 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1939 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001940 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001941 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001942 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1943
1944 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001945
1946 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1947 and won't try to remove them.
1948
1949 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1950
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001951ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001952 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001953 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1954 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1955 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001956
1957 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1958 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1959 optimize the startup time.
1960
1961 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1962 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1963 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1964
1965 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001966 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001967
1968 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001969 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1970 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001971
1972 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1973 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1974 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1975 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1976 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001977 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001978
1979 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001980 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001981 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1982 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1983 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1984 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1985 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001986 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001987
1988 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1989
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001990 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001991 a cert bundle.
1992
1993 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1994 separately in several "crt".
1995
1996 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1997 since files are loading separately.
1998
1999 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2000 required to commit them.
2001
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002002 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002003 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002004
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002005 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2006 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2007 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002008
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002009 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2010 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2011 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002012
2013 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002014 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2015 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002016
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002017 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2018 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2019
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002020 The default behavior is "all".
2021
2022 Example:
2023 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2024 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2025 ssl-load-extra-files none
2026
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002027 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2028 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002029
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002030ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2031 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2032 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2033 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2034
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002035ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002036 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002037 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2038 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2039 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2040 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2041 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2042 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002043 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002044
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002045stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2046 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2047 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2048 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002049 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002050 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002051
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002052 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2053 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2054 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002055
2056stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2057 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2058 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002059 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002060
2061stats maxconn <connections>
2062 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2063 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2064
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002065uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002066 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002067 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2068 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2069 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2070
2071ulimit-n <number>
2072 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2073 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2074 option.
2075
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002076 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2077 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2078 manually specify this value.
2079
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002080unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2081 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2082
2083 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2084 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2085 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2086 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2087 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002088 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002089 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2090 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2091 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2092 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2093
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002094unsetenv [<name> ...]
2095 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2096 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2097 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2098 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2099 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2100 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2101 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2102
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002103user <user name>
2104 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2105 See also "uid" and "group".
2106
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002107node <name>
2108 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2109
2110 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2111 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2112 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2113 traffic.
2114
2115description <text>
2116 Add a text that describes the instance.
2117
2118 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2119 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2120 "<" and ">" characters.
2121
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100212251degrees-data-file <file path>
2123 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002124 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002125
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002126 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002127 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2128
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000212951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002130 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2131 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2132 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2133
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002134 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002135 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2136
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200213751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002138 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2139 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2140
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002141 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002142 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2143
214451degrees-cache-size <number>
2145 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2146 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2147 By default, this cache is disabled.
2148
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002149 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002150 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2151
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002152wurfl-data-file <file path>
2153 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2154 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2155
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002156 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002157 with USE_WURFL=1.
2158
2159wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2160 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2161 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2162 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2163
2164 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2165
2166 Valid WURFL properties are:
2167 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2168
2169 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2170 device.
2171
2172 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2173 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2174
2175 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2176 particular web request.
2177
2178 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2179 used Libwurfl API version.
2180
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002181 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2182 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2183
2184 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2185 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2186
2187 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2188
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002189 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002190 with USE_WURFL=1.
2191
2192wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2193 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2194 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2195
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002196 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002197 with USE_WURFL=1.
2198
2199wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2200 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2201 thus before the chroot.
2202
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002203 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002204 with USE_WURFL=1.
2205
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002206wurfl-cache-size <size>
2207 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2208 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002209 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002210 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002211
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002212 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002213 with USE_WURFL=1.
2214
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002215strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002216 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002217 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2218 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002219 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002220 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002221
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022223.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002223-----------------------
2224
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002225busy-polling
2226 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2227 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2228 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2229 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2230 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2231 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2232 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2233 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2234 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2235 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2236 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2237 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2238 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2239 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2240 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2241 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2242 "poll" pollers.
2243
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002244 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2245 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2246 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2247
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002248max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002249 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002250 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2251 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2252 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2253 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2254 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2255 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2256 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2257
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002258maxconn <number>
2259 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2260 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2261 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002262 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2263 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2264 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2265 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002266 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2267 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2268 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2269 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2270 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2271 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002272
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002273maxconnrate <number>
2274 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2275 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2276 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2277 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2278 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2279 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2280 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2281 fairness.
2282
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002283maxcomprate <number>
2284 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002285 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002286 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2287 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2288 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002289 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002290 default value.
2291
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002292maxcompcpuusage <number>
2293 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2294 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2295 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002296 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2297 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2298 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2299 and from introducing high latencies.
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002300
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002301maxpipes <number>
2302 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2303 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2304 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2305 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2306 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2307 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2308
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002309maxsessrate <number>
2310 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2311 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2312 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2313 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2314 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2315 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2316 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2317 fairness.
2318
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002319maxsslconn <number>
2320 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2321 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2322 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2323 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2324 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2325 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2326 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002327 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2328 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2329 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2330 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002331 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002332 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2333 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002334
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002335maxsslrate <number>
2336 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2337 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2338 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2339 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2340 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2341 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2342 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2343 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2344 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2345 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2346
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002347maxzlibmem <number>
2348 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2349 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2350 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002351 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2352 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2353 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2354
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002355noepoll
2356 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2357 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002358 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002359
2360nokqueue
2361 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2362 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2363 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2364
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002365noevports
2366 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2367 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2368 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2369 also "nopoll".
2370
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002371nopoll
2372 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2373 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002374 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002375 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2376 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002377
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002378nosplice
2379 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002380 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002381 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002382 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002383 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2384 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2385 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2386 "option splice-response".
2387
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002388nogetaddrinfo
2389 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2390 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2391
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002392noreuseport
2393 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2394 command line argument "-dR".
2395
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002396profiling.memory { on | off }
2397 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2398 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2399 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2400 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2401 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2402 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2403 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2404 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2405 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2406
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002407profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2408 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2409 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2410 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2411 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002412 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002413 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2414 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2415 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2416 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2417
2418 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2419 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2420 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2421 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2422 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002423 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2424 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2425 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2426 CLI.
2427
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002428spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002429 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2430 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2431 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2432 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2433 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2434 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002435
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002436ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002437 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002438 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002439 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002440 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002441 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2442 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2443 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002444 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2445 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002446 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2447 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2448 openssl configuration file uses:
2449 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2450
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002451ssl-mode-async
2452 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002453 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002454 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2455 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002456 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002457 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002458 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002459
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002460tune.buffers.limit <number>
2461 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2462 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2463 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2464 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2465 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002466 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002467 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2468 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2469 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2470 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2471 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2472 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2473 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2474 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002475 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002476
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002477tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2478 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2479 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2480 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002481 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002482
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002483tune.bufsize <number>
2484 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2485 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2486 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2487 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2488 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2489 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2490 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002491 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2492 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002493 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002494 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002495 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002496 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2497 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002498
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002499tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2500 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2501 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2502 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2503 this value. The default value is 1.
2504
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002505tune.fail-alloc
2506 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2507 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2508 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2509 gracefully.
2510
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002511tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2512 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2513 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2514 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2515 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2516 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2517
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002518tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2519 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2520 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2521 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2522 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2523 change it.
2524
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002525tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2526 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002527 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002528 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002529 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2530 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2531 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2532 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2533 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2534
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002535tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2536 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2537 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2538 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2539 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2540 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002541 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002542 recommended not to change this value.
2543
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002544tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002545 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002546 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002547 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002548 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2549 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2550 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2551 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2552
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002553tune.http.cookielen <number>
2554 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2555 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2556 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2557 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2558 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2559 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2560 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2561 to change this value.
2562
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002563tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002564 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2565 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002566 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002567 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002568 configuration directives too.
2569 The default value is 1024.
2570
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002571tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2572 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2573 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2574 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2575 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2576 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2577 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002578 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2579 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2580 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002581
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002582tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2583 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2584 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2585 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2586 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2587 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2588 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002589 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2590 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2591 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2592 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2593 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002594
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002595tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002596 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002597 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2598 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2599 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2600 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002601 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002602 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002603 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002604 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2605
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002606tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2607 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2608 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2609 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2610 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2611 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2612 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2613 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2614 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2615 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2616
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002617tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2618 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002619 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002620 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2621 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002622 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002623 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2624 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2625
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002626tune.lua.maxmem
2627 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2628 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2629 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2630 memory.
2631
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002632tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2633 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002634 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2635 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002636 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002637
2638tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2639 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2640 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2641 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2642 check servers.
2643
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002644tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2645 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2646 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2647 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002648 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002649
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002650tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002651 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2652 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002653 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2654 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2655 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2656 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2657 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2658 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2659 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2660 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2661 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002662
2663tune.maxpollevents <number>
2664 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2665 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2666 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2667 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2668 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2669
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002670tune.maxrewrite <number>
2671 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2672 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2673 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2674 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2675 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2676 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2677 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2678 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2679 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2680 bufsize.
2681
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002682tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2683 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2684 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2685 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2686 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2687 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2688 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2689 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2690 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2691 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002692 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2693 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002694 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2695 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2696 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2697 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2698 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2699 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2700 setting this parameter to 0.
2701
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002702tune.pipesize <number>
2703 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2704 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2705 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2706 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2707 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2708 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2709
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002710tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2711 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002712 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002713 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2714 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2715 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2716 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002717 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002718
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002719tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2720 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002721 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002722 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2723 default is 20.
2724
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002725tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2726tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2727 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2728 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2729 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002730 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002731 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002732 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2733 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2734
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002735tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002736 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002737 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2738 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2739 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2740 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2741
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002742tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002743 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002744 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2745 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2746 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2747 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2748 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2749 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2750 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002751
2752tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2753 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002754 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002755 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2756 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2757 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2758 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2759 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2760 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2761 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002762
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002763tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2764tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2765 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2766 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2767 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002768 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002769 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002770 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2771 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2772 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2773 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002774 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002775
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002776tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002777 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002778 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2779 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2780 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2781 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2782 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2783 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2784 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2785 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2786 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002787 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
2788 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002789
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002790tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002791 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002792 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2793 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2794 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2795 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2796 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2797
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002798tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2799 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2800 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2801 performances. This is disabled by default.
2802
2803 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2804 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2805
2806 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2807
2808 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2809
2810 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2811
2812 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2813 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2814 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2815
2816 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2817 converted.
2818
2819 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2820 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2821 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2822 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2823 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2824 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2825 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002826 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2827 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002828
2829 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2830
2831 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2832 only need this line:
2833
2834 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2835
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002836tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2837 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002838 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002839 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2840 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2841 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2842 being used for too long.
2843
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002844tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2845 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2846 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2847 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2848 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2849 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2850 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2851 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2852 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2853 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2854 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002855 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002856 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002857
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002858tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2859 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2860 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2861 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2862 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002863 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002864 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2865 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002866 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2867 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002868
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002869tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2870 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2871 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2872 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2873 1000 entries.
2874
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02002875tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
2876tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
Marcin Deranek769fd2e2021-07-12 14:16:55 +02002877 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2878 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2879 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2880 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002881
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002882tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002883tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002884tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2885tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2886tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002887 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2888 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2889 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2890 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2891 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2892 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2893 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2894 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002895
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002896 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2897 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2898 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2899 all available space is consumed.
2900 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2901 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2902 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002903
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002904tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2905 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002906 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002907 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002908 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002909 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2910
2911tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2912 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2913 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002914 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2915 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002916
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029173.3. Debugging
2918--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002919
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002920quiet
2921 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2922 line argument "-q".
2923
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002924zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002925 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002926 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2927 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2928 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2929 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2930 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2931
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002932
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029333.4. Userlists
2934--------------
2935It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2936http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2937it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2938
2939userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002940 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002941 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2942
2943group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002944 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002945 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2946 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2947
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002948user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2949 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002950 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2951 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002952 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2953 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2954 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2955 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002956
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002957 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2958 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2959 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2960 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2961 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2962 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2963 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002964 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002965 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002966
2967 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002968 userlist L1
2969 group G1 users tiger,scott
2970 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002971
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002972 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2973 user scott insecure-password elgato
2974 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002975
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002976 userlist L2
2977 group G1
2978 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002979
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002980 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2981 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2982 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002983
2984 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002985
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002986
29873.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002988----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002989It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002990several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002991instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2992values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2993automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2994In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2995using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2996tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2997reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2998Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2999that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3000each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003001
3002peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003003 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003004 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3005
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003006bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3007 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3008 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3009
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003010disabled
3011 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3012 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3013 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3014
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003015default-bind [param*]
3016 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3017
3018default-server [param*]
3019 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3020
3021 Arguments:
3022 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3023 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3024 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3025 details.
3026
3027
3028 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3029
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003030enable
3031 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
3032
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003033log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003034 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3035 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3036 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3037 more details.
3038
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003039peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003040 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3041 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003042 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003043 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003044 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3045 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3046 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003047
3048 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3049 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3050
3051 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003052 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3053 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3054 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003055
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003056 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3057 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003058
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003059 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3060 "server" keyword explanation below).
3061
3062server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003063 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003064 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
3065 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
3066 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
3067 of this "peers" section).
3068 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
3069
3070
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003071 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003072 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003073 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003074 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3075 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3076 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003077
3078 backend mybackend
3079 mode tcp
3080 balance roundrobin
3081 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3082 stick on src
3083
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003084 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3085 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003086
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003087 Example:
3088 peers mypeers
3089 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3090 default-server ssl verify none
3091 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3092 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003093
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003094
3095table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3096 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3097
3098 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3099 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003100 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003101 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3102 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3103 "stick-table" keyword).
3104
3105 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3106 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3107 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3108 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3109 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3110 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3111 of the stick-table name as follows:
3112
3113 peers mypeers
3114 peer A ...
3115 peer B ...
3116 table t1 ...
3117
3118 frontend fe1
3119 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3120
3121 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3122 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3123
3124 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3125 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3126 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3127 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3128 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3129 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3130 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3131
3132 peers mypeers
3133 peer A ...
3134 peer B ...
3135 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3136
3137 backend t1
3138 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3139
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003140 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003141 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3142 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3143
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031443.6. Mailers
3145------------
3146It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3147If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3148in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3149
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003150mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003151 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3152 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3153
3154mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3155 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3156
3157 Example:
3158 mailers mymailers
3159 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3160 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3161
3162 backend mybackend
3163 mode tcp
3164 balance roundrobin
3165
3166 email-alert mailers mymailers
3167 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3168 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3169
3170 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3171 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3172
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003173timeout mail <time>
3174 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3175 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3176 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3177 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3178
3179 Example:
3180 mailers mymailers
3181 timeout mail 20s
3182 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003183
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031843.7. Programs
3185-------------
3186In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3187master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3188managed the same way as the workers.
3189
3190During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3191sequence as a worker:
3192
3193 - the master is re-executed
3194 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3195 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3196 instance of the program
3197
3198During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3199
3200program <name>
3201 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3202 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3203 the management guide).
3204
3205command <command> [arguments*]
3206 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3207 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3208 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3209 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3210
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003211user <user name>
3212 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3213 See also "group".
3214
3215group <group name>
3216 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3217 See also "user".
3218
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003219option start-on-reload
3220no option start-on-reload
3221 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3222 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3223 program section.
3224
3225
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010032263.8. HTTP-errors
3227----------------
3228
3229It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3230imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3231several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3232
3233http-errors <name>
3234 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3235 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3236
3237errorfile <code> <file>
3238 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3239
3240 Arguments :
3241 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003242 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003243 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003244
3245 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3246 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3247 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3248 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3249 before any chroot is performed.
3250
3251 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3252
3253 Example:
3254 http-errors website-1
3255 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3256 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3257 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3258
3259 http-errors website-2
3260 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3261 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3262 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3263
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032643.9. Rings
3265----------
3266
3267It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3268servers or traces.
3269
3270ring <ringname>
3271 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3272
3273description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003274 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003275 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3276
3277format <format>
3278 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3279
3280 Arguments:
3281 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3282 one of the following :
3283
3284 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3285 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3286 designed to be used with a local log server.
3287
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003288 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3289 field is stripped. This is the default.
3290 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3291 rfc3164.
3292
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003293 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3294 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3295 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3296 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3297 is the default.
3298
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003299 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003300 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3301
3302 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3303 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3304
3305 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3306 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3307 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3308 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3309 logger consumes.
3310
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003311 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3312 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3313 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3314 with a local log server.
3315
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003316 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3317 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3318 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3319 used with a local log server.
3320
3321maxlen <length>
3322 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3323 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3324 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3325
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003326server <name> <address> [param*]
3327 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3328 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3329 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3330 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3331 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3332 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3333 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3334 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3335 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003336 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3337 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003338
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003339size <size>
3340 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3341 set to BUFSIZE.
3342
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003343timeout connect <timeout>
3344 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3345
3346 Arguments :
3347 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3348 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3349 as explained at the top of this document.
3350
3351timeout server <timeout>
3352 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3353
3354 Arguments :
3355 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3356 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3357 as explained at the top of this document.
3358
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003359 Example:
3360 global
3361 log ring@myring local7
3362
3363 ring myring
3364 description "My local buffer"
3365 format rfc3164
3366 maxlen 1200
3367 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003368 timeout connect 5s
3369 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003370 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003371
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033723.10. Log forwarding
3373-------------------
3374
3375It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003376HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003377
3378log-forward <name>
3379 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3380
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003381backlog <conns>
3382 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3383 on connections accept.
3384
3385bind <addr> [param*]
3386 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003387 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3388 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3389 syslog protocol over TCP.
3390 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003391 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3392
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003393dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003394 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3395 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3396 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3397 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003398 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003399
3400log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003401log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003402 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3403 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3404 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003405 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003406 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3407 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3408 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003409 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003410
3411 Example:
3412 global
3413 log stderr format iso local7
3414
3415 ring myring
3416 description "My local buffer"
3417 format rfc5424
3418 maxlen 1200
3419 size 32764
3420 timeout connect 5s
3421 timeout server 10s
3422 # syslog tcp server
3423 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3424
3425 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003426 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3427 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003428 # all messages on stderr
3429 log global
3430 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3431 log ring@myring local0
3432 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3433 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3434 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3435 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3436 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003437
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003438maxconn <conns>
3439 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3440 10 is the default.
3441
3442timeout client <timeout>
3443 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034454. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003446----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003447
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003448Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003449 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3450 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3451 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3452 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003453
3454A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3455connections.
3456
3457A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3458to forward incoming connections.
3459
3460A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3461parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3462
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003463A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3464ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3465sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3466the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3467explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3468from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3469"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3470for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3471to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3472optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3473are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3474any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3475names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3476that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3477duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3478names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3479
3480Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3481settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3482of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3483profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3484timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3485
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003486All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3487'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3488case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3489
3490Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3491logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3492proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3493However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3494name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3495
3496Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3497and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003498bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003499protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3500modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3501arbitrary criteria.
3502
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003503In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3504a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003505the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003506
3507 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3508 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3509 between responses and new requests.
3510
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003511 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3512 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3513 client-facing connection remains open.
3514
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003515 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3516 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003517
3518The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3519frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3520following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003521weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003522
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003523 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003524
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003525 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3526 ----+-----+-----+----
3527 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3528 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003529 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3530 ----+-----+-----+----
3531 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003532
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003533It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003534only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3535within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003536as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003537content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003538and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3539possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003540
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003541There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003542first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003543processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003544second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003545protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3546is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3547new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003548to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003549process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3550already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3551HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3552evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3553one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3554
3555There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3556performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3557tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3558preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3559analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3560HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3561header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3562mitigate this drawback.
3563
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003564There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003565method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3566set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3567in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3568is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3569to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3570above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3571to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3572"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3573frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3574frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3575as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3576upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3577on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3578the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3579upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3580frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3581remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003582
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035834.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3584--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003585
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003586The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3587limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3588they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3589limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003590marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003591option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003592and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3593with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3594specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003595
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003596
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003597 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3598------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3599acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003600backlog X X X -
3601balance X - X X
3602bind - X X -
3603bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003604capture cookie - X X -
3605capture request header - X X -
3606capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003607clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3608clitcpka-idle X X X -
3609clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003610compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003611cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003612declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003613default-server X - X X
3614default_backend X X X -
3615description - X X X
3616disabled X X X X
3617dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003618email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003619email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003620email-alert mailers X X X X
3621email-alert myhostname X X X X
3622email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003623enabled X X X X
3624errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003625errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003626errorloc X X X X
3627errorloc302 X X X X
3628-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3629errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02003630error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003631force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003632filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003633fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003634hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003635http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003636http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003637http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003638http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003639http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003640http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003641http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003642http-check set-var X - X X
3643http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003644http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003645http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003646http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003647http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003648http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003649id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003650ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003651load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003652log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003653log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003654log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003655log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003656max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003657maxconn X X X -
3658mode X X X X
3659monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003660monitor-uri X X X -
3661option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3662option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3663option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3664option allbackups (*) X - X X
3665option checkcache (*) X - X X
3666option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3667option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003668option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003669option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3670option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003671-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3672option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003673option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3674option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003675option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003676option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003677option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003678option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003679option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003680option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3681option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3682option httpchk X - X X
3683option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003684option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02003685option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003686option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003687option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003688option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003689option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3690option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3691option logasap (*) X X X -
3692option mysql-check X - X X
3693option nolinger (*) X X X X
3694option originalto X X X X
3695option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003696option pgsql-check X - X X
3697option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003698option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003699option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003700option smtpchk X - X X
3701option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3702option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3703option splice-request (*) X X X X
3704option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003705option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003706option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3707option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3708-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003709option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003710option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3711option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3712option tcpka X X X X
3713option tcplog X X X X
3714option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003715external-check command X - X X
3716external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003717persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3718rate-limit sessions X X X -
3719redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003720-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003721retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003722retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003723server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003724server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003725server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003726source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003727srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3728srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3729srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003730stats admin - X X X
3731stats auth X X X X
3732stats enable X X X X
3733stats hide-version X X X X
3734stats http-request - X X X
3735stats realm X X X X
3736stats refresh X X X X
3737stats scope X X X X
3738stats show-desc X X X X
3739stats show-legends X X X X
3740stats show-node X X X X
3741stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003742-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3743stick match - - X X
3744stick on - - X X
3745stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003746stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003747stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003748tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003749tcp-check connect X - X X
3750tcp-check expect X - X X
3751tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003752tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003753tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003754tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003755tcp-check set-var X - X X
3756tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003757tcp-request connection - X X -
3758tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003759tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003760tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003761tcp-response content - - X X
3762tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003763timeout check X - X X
3764timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003765timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003766timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003767timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3768timeout http-request X X X X
3769timeout queue X - X X
3770timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003771timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003772timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003773timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003774transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003775unique-id-format X X X -
3776unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003777use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003778use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003779use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003780------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3781 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003782
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003783
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037844.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3785---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003786
3787This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3788
3789
3790acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3791 Declare or complete an access list.
3792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3793 no | yes | yes | yes
3794 Example:
3795 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3796 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3797 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3798
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003799 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003800
3801
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003802backlog <conns>
3803 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3805 yes | yes | yes | no
3806 Arguments :
3807 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3808 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003809 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003810
3811 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3812 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3813 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3814 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3815 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3816 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3817 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3818 backlog parameter.
3819
3820 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3821 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3822 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3823
3824 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3825
3826
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003827balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003828balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003829 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3831 yes | no | yes | yes
3832 Arguments :
3833 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3834 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3835 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3836 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3837
3838 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3839 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3840 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3841 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003842 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003843 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003844 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3845 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3846 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3847 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3848 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3849 it, so that you don't worry.
3850
3851 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3852 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3853 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3854 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3855 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3856 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3857 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3858 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003859
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003860 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3861 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3862 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3863 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3864 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3865 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3866 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003867 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3868 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3869 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003870
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003871 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003872 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003873 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3874 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003875 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003876 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3877 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3878 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3879 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3880 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003881 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3882 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3883 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3884 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3885 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3886 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003887
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003888 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3889 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3890 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3891 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3892 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3893 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3894 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3895 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003896 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003897 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003898 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3899 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3900 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003901
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003902 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3903 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3904 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3905 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3906 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3907 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3908 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3909 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3910 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3911 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3912 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3913 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003914
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003915 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003916 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3917 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3918 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3919 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3920 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3921 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3922 URIs start with a leading "/".
3923
3924 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3925 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3926 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3927 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3928
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003929 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3930 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3931 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3932 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3933
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003934 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003935 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3936
3937 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003938 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3939 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003940 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3941 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3942 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3943 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003944 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003945 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3946 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003947
3948 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3949 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3950 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3951 server will receive the request.
3952
3953 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3954 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3955 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3956 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3957 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003958 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3959 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3960 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003961
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003962 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3963 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3964 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3965 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3966 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003967
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003968 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003969 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3970 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3971 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3972
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003973 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3974 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3975 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3976
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003977 random
3978 random(<draws>)
3979 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003980 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3981 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3982 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3983 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003984 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3985 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3986 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3987 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3988 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3989 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3990 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3991 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3992 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3993 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3994 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3995 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3996 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3997 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3998 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3999 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4000 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4001 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4002 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4003 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004004
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004005 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004006 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004007 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4008 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
4009 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
4010 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4011 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4012 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004013 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004014 used instead.
4015
4016 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4017 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4018 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
4019 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
4020
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004021 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4022 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4023 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4024
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004025 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004026
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004027 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004028 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4029 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004030
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004031 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4032 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4033 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004034
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004035 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004036 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004037 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4038 NTLM relies on.
4039
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004040 Examples :
4041 balance roundrobin
4042 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004043 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004044 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4045 balance hdr(host)
4046 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004047
4048 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4049 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4050
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004051 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004052 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4053 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4054 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004055 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004056
4057 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4058 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4059 defaults to 16 kB.
4060
4061 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4062 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4063
4064 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4065 Round Robin.
4066
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004067 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004068 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4069 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4070 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4071
4072 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4073
4074 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004075 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004076 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4077 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4078 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004079
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004080 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004081
4082
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004083bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4084bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004085 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4087 no | yes | yes | no
4088 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004089 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4090 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4091 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4092 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004093 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004094 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4095 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4096 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4097 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4098 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4099 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004100 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004101 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4102 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004103 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004104 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4105 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004106 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004107 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4108 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004109 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004110 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004111 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4112 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4113 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004114 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4115 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4116 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4117 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004118 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4119 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4120 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004121
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004122 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4123 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004124 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4125 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4126 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004127 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4128 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4129 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4130 the range.
4131
4132 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4133 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4134 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4135 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4136 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4137 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4138 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004139 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004140 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004141
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004142 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004143 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004144 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4145 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4146 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4147 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4148 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4149 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4150
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004151 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4152 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4153 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4154 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004155
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004156 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4157 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4158 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4159 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4160 in a frontend.
4161
4162 Example :
4163 listen http_proxy
4164 bind :80,:443
4165 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004166 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004167
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004168 listen http_https_proxy
4169 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004170 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004171
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004172 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4173 bind ipv6@:80
4174 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4175 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4176
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004177 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004178 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004179
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004180 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4181 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4182 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4183 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4184 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4185
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004186 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004187 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004188
4189
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004190bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4192 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004193
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02004194 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some
4195 frontends on certain processes only, or to adjust backends so that they
4196 could match the frontends that used them. The default and only accepted
4197 value is "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this
4198 setting. Threads can still be bound per-socket using the "process" bind
4199 keyword.
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004200
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02004201 See also : "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004202
4203
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004204capture cookie <name> len <length>
4205 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4207 no | yes | yes | no
4208 Arguments :
4209 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4210 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4211 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4212 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004213 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004214
4215 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4216 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4217 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4218 right if it exceeds <length>.
4219
4220 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4221 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4222 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4223 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4224
4225 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4226 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4227 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4228
4229 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4230 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4231 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004232 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4233 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4234 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004235
4236 Example:
4237 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4238
4239 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004240 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004241
4242
4243capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004244 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4246 no | yes | yes | no
4247 Arguments :
4248 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004249 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004250 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4251 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4252 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4253
4254 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4255 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4256 it exceeds <length>.
4257
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004258 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004259 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4260 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004261 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4262 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4263 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4264 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004265 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004266 environments to find where the request came from.
4267
4268 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4269 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4270 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4271 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004272
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004273 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4274 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4275 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4276 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4277 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004278
4279 Example:
4280 capture request header Host len 15
4281 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004282 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004283
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004284 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004285 about logging.
4286
4287
4288capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004289 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4291 no | yes | yes | no
4292 Arguments :
4293 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004294 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004295 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4296 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4297 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4298
4299 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4300 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4301 it exceeds <length>.
4302
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004303 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004304 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4305 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4306 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004307 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4308 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4309 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4310 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004311
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004312 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4313 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4314 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4315 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4316 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004317
4318 Example:
4319 capture response header Content-length len 9
4320 capture response header Location len 15
4321
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004322 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004323 about logging.
4324
4325
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004326clitcpka-cnt <count>
4327 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4328 the connection on the client side.
4329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4330 yes | yes | yes | no
4331 Arguments :
4332 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4333
4334 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4335 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004336 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4337 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004338
4339 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4340
4341
4342clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4343 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4344 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4345 client side.
4346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4347 yes | yes | yes | no
4348 Arguments :
4349 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4350 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4351 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4352 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4353
4354 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4355 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004356 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4357 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004358
4359 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4360
4361
4362clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4363 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4365 yes | yes | yes | no
4366 Arguments :
4367 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4368 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4369 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4370 document.
4371
4372 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4373 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004374 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4375 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004376
4377 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4378
4379
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004380compression algo <algorithm> ...
4381compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004382compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004383 Enable HTTP compression.
4384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4385 yes | yes | yes | yes
4386 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004387 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4388 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004389 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004390
4391 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004392 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4393 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4394 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004395
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004396 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004397 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004398
4399 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4400 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4401 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4402 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4403 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004404 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004405
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004406 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4407 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4408 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4409 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4410 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4411 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4412 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004413 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004414
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004415 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004416 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004417 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004418 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004419 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004420 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004421 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004422
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004423 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004424 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4425 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004426 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4427 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004428 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004429 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004430 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4431 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004432 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004433 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4434 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004435
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004436 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004437 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4438 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004439 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004440 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004441 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4442 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4443 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4444 "multipart"
4445 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4446 header
4447 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4448 and later
4449 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4450 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004451 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004452
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004453 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004454
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004455 Examples :
4456 compression algo gzip
4457 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004458
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004459
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004460cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004461 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4462 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004463 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004464 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4466 yes | no | yes | yes
4467 Arguments :
4468 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4469 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4470 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4471 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4472 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4473 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004474 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004475 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4476 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4477
4478 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004479 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004480 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4481 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4482 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4483 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004484 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4485 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004486 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004487 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4488 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004489
4490 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004491 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004492
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004493 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004494 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004495 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004496 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004497 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4498 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4499 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4500 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4501 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4502 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4503 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004504
4505 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4506 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4507 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4508 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4509 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4510 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4511 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4512 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4513 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004514 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004515 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4516 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4517 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004518
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004519 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4520 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4521 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004522 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4523 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4524 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4525 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004526 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4527 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4528 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004529
4530 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4531 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4532 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4533 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4534 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4535 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4536 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4537 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4538 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4539
4540 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4541 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4542 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4543 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4544 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4545 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4546 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4547 persistence cookie in the cache.
4548 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4549
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004550 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4551 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004552 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004553 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4554 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004555 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004556 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4557 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4558 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4559 they logout.
4560
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004561 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004562 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4563 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4564 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4565
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004566 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004567 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4568 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4569 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4570 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4571 this attribute.
4572
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004573 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004574 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004575 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4576 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4577 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4578 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4579 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4580 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004581
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004582 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4583 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4584 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4585 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4586 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4587 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4588 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4589 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004590 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004591 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4592 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4593 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4594 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4595 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4596 the site.
4597
4598 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4599 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4600 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4601 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4602 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4603 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4604 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4605 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4606 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4607 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4608 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4609 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4610 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004611 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004612 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4613 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4614
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004615 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4616 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4617 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4618 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4619 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4620 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4621
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004622 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004623 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4624 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4625 repeated.
4626
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004627 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4628 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4629 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4630 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004631
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004632 Examples :
4633 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4634 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4635 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004636 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004637
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004638 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004639
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004640
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004641declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4642 Declares a capture slot.
4643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4644 no | yes | yes | no
4645 Arguments:
4646 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4647
4648 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4649 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4650 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4651 for use in the response.
4652
4653 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004654 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004655 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4656
4657
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004658default-server [param*]
4659 Change default options for a server in a backend
4660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4661 yes | no | yes | yes
4662 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004663 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4664 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4665 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4666 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004667
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004668 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004669 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4670
4671 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004672
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004673
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004674default_backend <backend>
4675 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4677 yes | yes | yes | no
4678 Arguments :
4679 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4680
4681 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4682 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4683 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4684 will catch all undetermined requests.
4685
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004686 Example :
4687
4688 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4689 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4690 default_backend dynamic
4691
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004692 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004693
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004694
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004695description <string>
4696 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4698 no | yes | yes | yes
4699 Arguments : string
4700
4701 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4702 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4703 it describes.
4704 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4705
4706
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004707disabled
4708 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4710 yes | yes | yes | yes
4711 Arguments : none
4712
4713 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4714 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4715 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4716 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4717 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4718 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4719 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4720
4721 See also : "enabled"
4722
4723
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004724dispatch <address>:<port>
4725 Set a default server address
4726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4727 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004728 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004729
4730 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4731 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4732 during start-up.
4733
4734 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4735 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4736 possible with normal servers.
4737
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004738 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004739 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4740 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4741 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4742 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4743
4744 See also : "server"
4745
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004746
4747dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4748 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4750 yes | no | yes | yes
4751 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4752
4753 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004754 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004755 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4756 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004757 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004758 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004759
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004760enabled
4761 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4763 yes | yes | yes | yes
4764 Arguments : none
4765
4766 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4767 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4768
4769 See also : "disabled"
4770
4771
4772errorfile <code> <file>
4773 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4775 yes | yes | yes | yes
4776 Arguments :
4777 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004778 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004779 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004780
4781 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004782 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004783 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004784 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4785 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004786
4787 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4788 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4789 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4790
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004791 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4792
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004793 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4794 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4795 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4796 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4797 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4798 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4799 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4800 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4801 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004802
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004803 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4804 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4805 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004806 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004807 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4808
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004809 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004810
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004811 Example :
4812 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004813 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004814 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4815 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4816
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004817
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004818errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4819 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4820 section.
4821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4822 yes | yes | yes | yes
4823 Arguments :
4824 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4825
4826 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004827 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004828 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4829 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004830
4831 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4832 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4833 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4834 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4835 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004836 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004837 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4838
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004839 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4840 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004841
4842 Example :
4843 errorfiles generic
4844 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4845
4846
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004847errorloc <code> <url>
4848errorloc302 <code> <url>
4849 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4851 yes | yes | yes | yes
4852 Arguments :
4853 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004854 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004855 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004856
4857 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4858 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4859 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4860 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004861 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004862
4863 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4864 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4865 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4866
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004867 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4868
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004869 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4870 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4871 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4872 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004873 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004874 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4875 request.
4876
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004877 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004878
4879
4880errorloc303 <code> <url>
4881 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4883 yes | yes | yes | yes
4884 Arguments :
4885 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004886 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004887 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004888
4889 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4890 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4891 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4892 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004893 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004894
4895 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4896 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4897 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4898
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004899 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4900
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004901 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4902 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4903 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4904 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004905 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004906
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004907 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004908
4909
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004910email-alert from <emailaddr>
4911 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004912 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004913 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4914 yes | yes | yes | yes
4915
4916 Arguments :
4917
4918 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4919
4920 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4921 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4922
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004923 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004924 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4925 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004926
4927
4928email-alert level <level>
4929 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4930 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4931 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4932 yes | yes | yes | yes
4933
4934 Arguments :
4935
4936 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4937 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4938 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4939
4940 By default level is alert
4941
4942 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4943 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4944 for the proxy.
4945
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004946 Alerts are sent when :
4947
4948 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4949 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4950 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4951 is notice or lower
4952 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4953 and a health check status update occurs
4954
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004955 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4956 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004957 section 3.6 about mailers.
4958
4959
4960email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4961 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4962 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4963 yes | yes | yes | yes
4964
4965 Arguments :
4966
4967 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4968
4969 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4970 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4971
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004972 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4973 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004974
4975
4976email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4977 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4978 mailers.
4979 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4980 yes | yes | yes | yes
4981
4982 Arguments :
4983
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004984 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004985
4986 By default the systems hostname is used.
4987
4988 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4989 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4990 for the proxy.
4991
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004992 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4993 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004994
4995
4996email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004997 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004998 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4999 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5000 yes | yes | yes | yes
5001
5002 Arguments :
5003
5004 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5005
5006 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5007 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5008
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005009 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005010 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5011
5012
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005013error-log-format <string>
5014 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5015 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5016 yes | yes | yes | no
5017
5018 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5019 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5020 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5021 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
5022 connection errors described in section 8.2.6..
5023 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5024 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5025 string in depth.
5026
5027 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5028 directives.
5029
5030
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005031force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5032 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5033 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005034 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005035
5036 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5037 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5038 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5039 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5040 marked down for maintenance operations.
5041
5042 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5043 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5044 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5045 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5046 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5047 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5048 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5049 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5050 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5051
5052 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5053 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5054 is used.
5055
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005056 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005057 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005058
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005059
5060filter <name> [param*]
5061 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5063 no | yes | yes | yes
5064 Arguments :
5065 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5066 referenced in section 9.
5067
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005068 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005069 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005070 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5071 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005072
5073 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5074 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5075
5076 Example:
5077 listen
5078 bind *:80
5079
5080 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5081 filter compression
5082 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5083
5084 compression algo gzip
5085 compression offload
5086
5087 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5088
5089 See also : section 9.
5090
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005091
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005092fullconn <conns>
5093 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5095 yes | no | yes | yes
5096 Arguments :
5097 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5098 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5099
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005100 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005101 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005102 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005103 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5104 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5105 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5106 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5107 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005108 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005109
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005110 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005111 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005112 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5113 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5114 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005115
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005116 Example :
5117 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5118 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5119 # connections.
5120 backend dynamic
5121 fullconn 10000
5122 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5123 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5124
5125 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5126
5127
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005128hash-balance-factor <factor>
5129 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5131 yes | no | no | yes
5132 Arguments :
5133 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5134 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005135 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005136
5137 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5138 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5139 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5140 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5141 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5142 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5143 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5144
5145 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5146 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5147 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5148 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5149 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5150
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005151 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5152 consistent hashing mechanism.
5153
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005154 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5155
5156
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005157hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005158 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5160 yes | no | yes | yes
5161 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005162 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5163 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005164
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005165 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5166 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5167 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5168 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5169 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5170 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5171 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5172 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5173 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5174 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005175
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005176 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5177 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5178 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5179 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5180 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5181 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5182 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5183 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5184 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5185 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5186 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5187 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5188 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005189 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5190 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005191
5192 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5193
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005194 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005195 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5196 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5197 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005198 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5199 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5200 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005201
5202 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5203 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005204 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5205 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5206 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5207 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5208
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005209 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005210 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5211 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5212 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5213 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5214 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5215 parameter.
5216
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005217 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5218 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5219 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5220 used on strings.
5221
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005222 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5223
5224 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5225 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5226 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5227 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5228 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5229 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5230 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5231 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5232 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5233 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5234 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5235 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005236
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005237 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5238 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5239 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005240
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005241 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005242
5243
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005244http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5245 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5246 ones).
5247
5248 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5249 no | yes | yes | yes
5250
5251 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5252 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5253 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5254 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5255 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5256 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5257
5258 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5259 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5260 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5261
5262 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5263 below.
5264
5265 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5266 instance.
5267
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005268 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5269 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5270 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5271
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005272 Example:
5273 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5274 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5275 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5276
5277http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5278
5279 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5280 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5281 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5282 example, or to pass some internal information.
5283 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5284 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5285 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5286
5287http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5288
5289 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5290 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5291
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005292http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005293
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005294 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5295 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5296 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5297 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5298 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005299
5300http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5301 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5302
5303 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5304
5305 Example:
5306 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5307
5308 # applied to:
5309 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5310
5311 # outputs:
5312 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5313
5314 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5315
5316http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5317 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5318
5319 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5320
5321 Example:
5322 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5323
5324 # applied to:
5325 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5326
5327 # outputs:
5328 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5329
5330http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5331
5332 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5333 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5334 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5335
5336http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5337 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5338
5339 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5340 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5341 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5342 fallback.
5343
5344 Example:
5345 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5346 http-response set-status 431
5347 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5348 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5349
5350http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005351http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005352 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5353 inline.
5354
5355 Arguments:
5356 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5357 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5358 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5359 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5360 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5361 (request and response)
5362 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5363 processing
5364 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5365 processing
5366 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5367 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5368 and '_'.
5369
5370 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5371 followed by some converters.
5372
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005373 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
5374 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
5375
5376 Examples:
5377 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5378 http-after-response set-var-fmt(sess.last_be_addr) %[bi]:%[bp]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005379
5380http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5381
5382 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5383 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5384 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5385 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5386 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005387 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005388 processing.
5389
5390 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5391 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005392 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005393 rules evaluation.
5394
5395http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5396
5397 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5398 details about <var-name>.
5399
5400 Example:
5401 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5402
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005403
5404http-check comment <string>
5405 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5406 it fails.
5407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5408 yes | no | yes | yes
5409
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005410 Arguments :
5411 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5412 rule fails.
5413
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005414 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5415 user-friendly error reporting.
5416
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005417 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005418 "http-check expect".
5419
5420
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005421http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5422 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005423 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005424 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5426 yes | no | yes | yes
5427
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005428 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005429 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5430
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005431 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005432 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005433
5434 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5435 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5436 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5437 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5438
5439 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5440
5441 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5442
5443 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5444
5445 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5446
5447 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5448
5449 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5450 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5451 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5452 is used.
5453
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005454 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5455 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5456 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5457 haproxy -vv.
5458
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005459 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5460
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005461 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5462 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5463 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5464 different ports or with different servers.
5465
5466 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5467 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5468 the port with a "http-check connect".
5469
5470 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5471 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5472 do.
5473
5474 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5475 unset-var or comment rules.
5476
5477 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005478 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5479 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5480 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5481 option httpchk
5482
5483 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005484 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005485 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005486 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005487 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005488 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005489
5490 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5491
5492 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005493
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005494
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005495http-check disable-on-404
5496 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005498 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005499 Arguments : none
5500
5501 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5502 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5503 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5504 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5505 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5506 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5507 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5508 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005509 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5510 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005511 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5512 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5513 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005514
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005515 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005516
5517
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005518http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005519 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5520 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5521 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005522 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005524 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005525
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005526 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005527 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5528
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005529 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5530 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5531 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5532 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5533 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5534 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5535 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5536 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5537 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5538 result is always conclusive.
5539
5540 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5541 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5542 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005543 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5544 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005545 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5546 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005547 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5548 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5549 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005550
5551 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5552 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005553 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5554 supported :
5555 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5556 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005557 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5558 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5559 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5560 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5561 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005562
5563 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5564 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005565 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5566 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5567 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5568 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005569 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5570
5571 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5572 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5573 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5574 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5575
5576 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5577 informational message reported in logs if an error
5578 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5579 log-format string.
5580
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005581 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005582 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5583 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005584 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5585 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5586 details on the supported keywords.
5587
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005588 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5589 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5590 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5591 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005592
5593 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5594 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5595 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5596 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5597 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5598
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005599 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5600 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5601 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5602 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5603 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5604 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5605 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005606
5607 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005608 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005609 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5610 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5611 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5612 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5613
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005614 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5615 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005616 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5617 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5618 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5619 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5620 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5621 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5622 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5623 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005624 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5625 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5626 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5627 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5628 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5629 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5630 insensitive on the header names.
5631
5632 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5633 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5634 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5635 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5636 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5637 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005638
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005639 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005640 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005641 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5642 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5643 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5644 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5645 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005646 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005647 trace).
5648
5649 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005650 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005651 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5652 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5653 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5654 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5655 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005656 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005657
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005658 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5659 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5660 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5661 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5662 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5663 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5664
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005665 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005666 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005667 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5668 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5669 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5670 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5671 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5672 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5673
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005674 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5675 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5676 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5677 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5678 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005679
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005680 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5681 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5682
5683 Examples :
5684 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005685 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005686
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005687 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5688 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5689
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005690 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005691 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005692
5693 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005694 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005695
5696 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005697 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005698
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005699 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005700 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005701
5702
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005703http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005704 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5705 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005706 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5707 health checks.
5708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5709 yes | no | yes | yes
5710 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005711 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5712
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005713 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5714 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5715 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5716 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5717 to invent non-standard ones.
5718
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005719 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5720 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5721 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5722 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5723
5724 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5725 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5726 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5727 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005728
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005729 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005730 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005731 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005732 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5733 to add it.
5734
5735 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5736 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5737 to the log-format rules.
5738
5739 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5740 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5741 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005742
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005743 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5744 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5745 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5746 request.
5747
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005748 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5749 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5750 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005751 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5752 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5753 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5754 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005755 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005756
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005757 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005758 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5759 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005760
5761 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5762 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5763 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5764 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5765 configured request authority.
5766
5767 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5768 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005769
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005770 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005771
5772
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005773http-check send-state
5774 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5776 yes | no | yes | yes
5777 Arguments : none
5778
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005779 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005780 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005781 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5782 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5783 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005784
5785 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5786 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5787 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5788 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5789 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005790 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5791 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5792 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5793
5794 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5795 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5796 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5797
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005798 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5799 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5800 checked in multiple backends.
5801
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005802 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005803 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5804
5805 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5806 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5807 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5808 one fails.
5809
5810 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5811 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5812 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5813
5814 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5815 server's queue.
5816
5817 Example of a header received by the application server :
5818 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5819 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5820
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005821 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5822 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005823
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005824
5825http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005826http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005827 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005828 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5829 yes | no | yes | yes
5830
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005831 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005832 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5833 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5834 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5835 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5836 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5837 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5838 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5839 and '-'.
5840
5841 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5842
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005843 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
5844 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
5845
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005846 Examples :
5847 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005848 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005849
5850
5851http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005852 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005853 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5854 yes | no | yes | yes
5855
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005856 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005857 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5858 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5859 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5860 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5861 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5862 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5863 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5864 and '-'.
5865
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005866 Examples :
5867 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005868
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005869
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005870http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5871 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5872 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5873 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5874 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5876 yes | yes | yes | yes
5877 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005878 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005879 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005880 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005881 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005882
5883 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5884 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5885 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5886 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5887
5888 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5889 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5890 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5891 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5892
5893 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5894 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5895 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5896 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5897 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5898 chroot is performed.
5899
5900 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5901 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5902 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5903 considered.
5904
5905 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5906 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5907 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5908 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5909 considered as a raw string.
5910
5911 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5912 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5913 "content-type".
5914
5915 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5916 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5917 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5918 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5919 evaluated as a log-format string.
5920
5921 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5922 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5923 argument to "content-type".
5924
5925 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5926 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5927 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5928 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5929
5930 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5931 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5932 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5933 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5934 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5935 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5936 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5937 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5938
5939 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5940 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5941 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5942
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005943 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5944 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5945 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5946 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5947 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5948
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005949 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5950 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5951
5952
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005953http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005954 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5955
5956 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5957 no | yes | yes | yes
5958
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005959 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5960 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5961 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5962 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5963 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005964
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005965 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5966 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005967
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005968 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005969
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005970 Example:
5971 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5972 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5973 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005974
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005975 http-request allow if nagios
5976 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5977 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5978 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005979
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005980 Example:
5981 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5982 acl add path /addacl
5983 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005984
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005985 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005986
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005987 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5988 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005989
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005990 Example:
5991 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5992 acl setmap path /setmap
5993 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005994
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005995 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005996
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005997 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5998 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005999
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006000 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6001 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006002
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006003http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006004
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006005 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6006 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6007 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6008 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6009 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6010 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6011 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6012 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006014http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006015
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006016 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6017 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6018 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6019 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6020 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6021 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6022 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6023 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006024
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006025http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006026
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006027 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6028 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006029
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006030
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006031http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006032
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006033 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6034 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6035 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6036 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6037 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006038
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006039 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6040 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6041 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6042 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6043 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6044 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6045 instead.
6046
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006047 Example:
6048 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6049 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006050
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006051http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006052
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006053 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006054
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006055http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6056 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006057
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006058 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6059 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6060 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6061 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6062 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6063 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6064 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6065 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6066 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006067
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006068 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6069 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6070 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006071 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6072
6073 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6074 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6075 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6076 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006077
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006078http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006079
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006080 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6081 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6082 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6083 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6084 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6085 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006086
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006087http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006088
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006089 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6090 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6091 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6092 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6093 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006094
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006095http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006097 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6098 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6099 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6100 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6101 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6102 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006103
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006104http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6105http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6106 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6107 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6108 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6109 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006110
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006111 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6112 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6113 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006114 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006115 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6116 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6117 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006118 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006119 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006120
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006121http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6122 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6123 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6124 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6125
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006126http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6127
6128 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6129 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6130 pointed by <resolvers>.
6131 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6132 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6133 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6134 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6135 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6136 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6137 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6138 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6139 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6140 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6141 to 0.0.0.0.
6142
6143 Example:
6144 resolvers mydns
6145 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6146 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6147 timeout retry 1s
6148 hold valid 10s
6149 hold nx 3s
6150 hold other 3s
6151 hold obsolete 0s
6152 accepted_payload_size 8192
6153
6154 frontend fe
6155 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6156 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6157 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6158
6159 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6160 # which mean DNS resolution error
6161 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6162
6163 default_backend be
6164
6165 backend b_503
6166 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6167 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6168 # 503 error page to end users
6169
6170 backend be
6171 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6172 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6173 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6174 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6175 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6176
6177 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6178 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6179
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006180http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6181
6182 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6183 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6184 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6185 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006186 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6187 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006188
6189 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6190
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006191http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006192http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006193http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006194http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006195http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006196http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006197http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006198http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6199http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006200
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006201 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6202
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006203 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006204 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6205 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6206 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6207 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006208
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006209 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6210 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6211 the supported backend.
6212
6213 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6214 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6215 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6216 number of segments in the path.
6217
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006218 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6219 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6220 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6221 when improperly combined.
6222
6223 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6224 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6225 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6226 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6227 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6228
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006229 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006230
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006231 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6232
6233 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6234 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6235
6236 Example:
6237 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6238
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006239 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6240
6241 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6242 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6243
6244 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6245 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6246
6247 Example:
6248 - /#foo -> /
6249
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006250 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6251 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006252
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006253 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6254 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6255
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006256 Example:
6257 - /. -> /
6258 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6259 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6260 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006261
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006262 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6263 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6264
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006265 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006266 their preceding segment.
6267
6268 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6269 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6270
6271 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6272 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006273
6274 Example:
6275 - /foo/../ -> /
6276 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6277 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6278 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006279 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006280 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006281 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006282
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006283 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6284 removed as well:
6285
6286 Example:
6287 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6288 - /bar/../../ -> /
6289
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006290 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6291 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006292
6293 Example:
6294 - // -> /
6295 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6296
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006297 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6298 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6299
6300 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6301 ".", "_", and "~".
6302
6303 Example:
6304 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6305 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6306 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6307 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6308
6309 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6310 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6311
6312 Example:
6313 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6314 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6315
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006316 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006317 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006318
6319 Example:
6320 - /%6f -> /%6F
6321 - /%zz -> /%zz
6322
6323 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6324 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6325
6326 Example:
6327 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6328
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006329 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006330 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6331 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6332
6333 Example:
6334 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6335 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6336 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006338http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006340 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6341 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6342 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6343 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6344 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006345
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006346http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006347
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006348 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6349 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6350 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6351 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006352
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006353http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6354 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006355
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006356 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006357 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6358 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6359 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6360 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6361 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006362
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006363 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6364 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6365 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6366 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6367 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006368
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006369 Example:
6370 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6371
6372 # applied to:
6373 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6374
6375 # outputs:
6376 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6377
6378 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006379
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006380 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6381
6382 # applied to:
6383 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006384
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006385 # outputs:
6386 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006387
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006388http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6389 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6390
6391 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6392 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006393 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6394 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6395 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006396
6397 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6398 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6399 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6400
6401 Example:
6402 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6403 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6404
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006405 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6406 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6407 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6408 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6409
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006410http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6411 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6412
6413 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6414 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6415 query-string are replaced.
6416
6417 Example:
6418 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6419 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6420
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006421http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6422 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6423
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006424 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6425 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6426 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6427 against.
6428
6429 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6430 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6431 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006432
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006433 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6434 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6435 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6436 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6437 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6438 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6439 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6440 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6441 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006442 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6443 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006444
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006445 Example:
6446 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6447 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006448
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006449 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6450 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006451
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006452http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6453 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006454
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006455 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6456 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6457 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6458 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006459
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006460 Example:
6461 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006462
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006463 # applied to:
6464 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006465
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006466 # outputs:
6467 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006468
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006469http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6470 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6471 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006472 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006473 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6474
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006475 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006476 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6477 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006478 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006479 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006480 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006481 are followed to create the response :
6482
6483 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6484 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6485 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6486 ignored.
6487
6488 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6489 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006490 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006491 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6492 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006493
6494 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6495 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6496 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006497 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006498 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006499
6500 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6501 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6502 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006503 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006504 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006505 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006506
6507 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6508 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6509 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6510 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6511 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6512 as a raw content.
6513
6514 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6515 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6516 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6517 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6518 considered as a raw string.
6519
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006520 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006521 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6522 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6523 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6524
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006525 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6526 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006527 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006528
6529 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6530
6531 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006532 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006533 if { path /ping }
6534
6535 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6536 if { path /favicon.ico }
6537
6538 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6539 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6540 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6541
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02006542http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6543
6544 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
6545 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
6546 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6547 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6548 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
6549 at this index.
6550 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
6551 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
6552
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006553http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6554http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006555
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006556 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6557 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6558 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006559
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02006560http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6561 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6562 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
6563 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
6564 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
6565 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6566 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6567 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
6568 at this index.
6569 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
6570 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
6571
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006572http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6573 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006574
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006575 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6576 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6577 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6578 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006580http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006582 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6583 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6584 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6585 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6586 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006587
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006588 Arguments:
6589 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6590 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006592 Example:
6593 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6594 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006596 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6597 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006599http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006601 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6602 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6603 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006604
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006605 Arguments:
6606 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6607 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006608
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006609 Example:
6610 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6611 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006613 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6614 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6615 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006617http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006619 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6620 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6621 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6622 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6623 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006625 Example:
6626 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6627 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6628 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6629 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6630 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6631 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6632 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6633 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6634 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006635
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006636http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006638 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6639 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6640 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6641 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6642 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006643
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006644http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6645 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006647 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6648 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6649 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6650 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6651 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6652 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6653 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6654 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6655 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006656
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006657http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006658
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01006659 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
6660 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6661 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
6662 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
6663 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
6664 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
6665 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01006666 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
6667 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006669http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006671 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6672 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6673 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006674
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006675http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006676
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006677 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6678 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6679 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6680 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6681 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6682 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6683 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6684 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006685
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006686http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006687
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006688 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6689 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6690 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6691 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6692 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6693 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006694
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006695 Example :
6696 # prepend the host name before the path
6697 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006698
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006699http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6700
6701 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6702 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6703 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6704
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006705http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006706
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006707 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6708 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6709 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6710 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6711 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006712
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006713http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006714
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006715 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6716 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6717 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6718 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6719 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6720 values have higher priority.
6721 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6722 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6723 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6724 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6725 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006726
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006727http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006728
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006729 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6730 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6731 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6732 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6733 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6734 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6735 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006736
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006737 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006738
6739 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006740 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6741 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006742
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006743http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6744 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6745 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6746 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006747 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6748 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006749
6750 Arguments :
6751 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6752 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006753
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006754 See also "option forwardfor".
6755
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006756 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006757 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6758 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6759
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006760 # After the masking this will track connections
6761 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6762 http-request track-sc0 src
6763
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006764 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6765 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6766
6767http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6768
6769 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6770 expression.
6771
6772 Arguments:
6773 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6774 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006775
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006776 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006777 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6778 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6779
6780 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6781 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6782 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6783
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006784http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006785 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6786
6787 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6788 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6789 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6790 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6791 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6792
6793 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6794 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6795 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6796 results.
6797
6798 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006799 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6800 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006801
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006802http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6803
6804 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6805 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6806 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6807 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6808 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6809 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6810 information from the request.
6811
6812 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6813
6814http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6815
6816 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6817 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6818 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6819 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6820 path and the query string.
6821 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6822
6823http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006824http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006825
6826 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6827 inline.
6828
6829 Arguments:
6830 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6831 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6832 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6833 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6834 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6835 (request and response)
6836 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6837 processing
6838 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6839 processing
6840 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6841 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6842 and '_'.
6843
6844 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6845 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006846
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006847 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6848 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6849
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006850 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006851 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006852 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
6853
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006854
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006855http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6856 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006857
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006858 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6859 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6860 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6861 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6862 agent name must be used.
6863
6864 Arguments:
6865 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6866
6867 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6868 configuration.
6869
6870http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6871
6872 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6873 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6874 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6875 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6876 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6877 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6878 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6879 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6880 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6881 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6882 action.
6883 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6884 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6885 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6886 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6887 you fully understand how it works.
6888
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006889http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6890
6891 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6892 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6893 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6894 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6895 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006896 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006897 processing.
6898
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006899 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006900 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6901 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6902 rules evaluation.
6903
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006904http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6905http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6906 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6907 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6908 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6909 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006910
6911 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6912 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6913 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006914 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6915 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6916 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6917 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6918 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6919 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006920 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006921 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6922 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6923 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006924 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006925 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6926 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6927 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6928 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6929 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006930
6931http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6932http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6933http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6934
6935 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6936 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6937 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6938 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006939 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006940 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6941 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6942 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6943 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6944 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6945 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6946 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6947
6948 Arguments :
6949 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6950 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6951 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6952 select which table entry to update the counters.
6953
6954 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6955 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6956 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6957 that table until the session ends.
6958
6959 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6960 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6961 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6962 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6963 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6964 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6965 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6966 useful information.
6967
6968 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6969 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6970 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6971 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6972 checks that make use of it.
6973
6974http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6975
6976 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006977
6978 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006979 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006980
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006981http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6982
6983 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6984 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6985 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6986 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6987 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6988 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6989
6990 Arguments :
6991 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6992
6993 Example:
6994 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6995
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006996http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6997 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6998
6999 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7000 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7001 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7002 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7003 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7004 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7005 http-buffer-request".
7006
7007 Arguments :
7008
7009 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7010 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7011
7012 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007013 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007014 bytes.
7015
7016 Example:
7017 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7018
7019 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7020
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007021http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007022
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007023 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7024 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7025 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007026
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007028http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007029 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7030
7031 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7032 no | yes | yes | yes
7033
7034 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7035 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7036 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7037 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7038 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7039 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007041 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7042 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007043
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007044 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007045
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007046 Example:
7047 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007048
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007049 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007050
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007051 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7052 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007054 Example:
7055 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007056
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007057 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007059 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7060 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007062 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7063 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007064
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007065http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007067 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7068 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7069 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7070 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7071 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7072 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7073 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7074 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007075
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007076http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007078 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7079 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7080 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7081 example, or to pass some internal information.
7082 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7083 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7084 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007085
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007086http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007087
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007088 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7089 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007090
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007091http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007092
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007093 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007094
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007095http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007096
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007097 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7098 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7099 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7100 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7101 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7102 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7103 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007104
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007105 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7106 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7107 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7108 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7109 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007110
7111 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7112 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7113 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7114 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007115
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007116http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007117
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007118 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7119 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7120 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7121 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7122 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7123 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007124
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007125http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007126
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007127 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7128 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7129 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7130 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7131 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007132
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007133http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007134
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007135 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7136 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7137 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7138 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7139 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7140 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007141
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007142http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7143http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7144 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7145 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7146 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7147 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007148
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007149 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7150 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7151 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007152 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007153 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7154 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7155 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007156 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007157 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007158
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007159http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007160
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007161 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7162 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7163 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7164 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7165 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7166 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007167
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007168http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7169 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007170
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007171 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7172 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007173
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007174 Example:
7175 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007176
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007177 # applied to:
7178 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007179
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007180 # outputs:
7181 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007182
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007183 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007184
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007185http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7186 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007187
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007188 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007189 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007190
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007191 Example:
7192 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007193
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007194 # applied to:
7195 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007196
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007197 # outputs:
7198 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007199
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007200http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7201 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7202 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007203 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007204 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7205
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007206 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007207 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7208 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007209 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007210 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007211 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007212 are followed to create the response :
7213
7214 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7215 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7216 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7217 ignored.
7218
7219 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7220 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007221 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007222 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7223 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007224
7225 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7226 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7227 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007228 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007229 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007230
7231 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7232 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7233 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007234 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007235 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007236 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007237
7238 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7239 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7240 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7241 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7242 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7243 as a raw content.
7244
7245 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7246 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7247 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7248 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7249 considered as a raw string.
7250
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007251 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7252 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7253 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7254 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7255
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007256 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7257 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007258 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007259
7260 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7261
7262 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007263 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007264 if { status eq 404 }
7265
7266 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7267 string "This is the end !" \
7268 if { status eq 500 }
7269
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007270http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7271
7272 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7273 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7274 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7275 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7276 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7277 at this index.
7278 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7279 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7280
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007281http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7282http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007283
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007284 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7285 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7286 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007287
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007288http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7289 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7290
7291 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7292 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7293 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7294 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7295 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7296 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7297 at this index.
7298 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7299 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7300
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007301http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7302 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007303
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007304 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7305 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7306 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7307 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007308
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007309http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7310 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007311
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007312 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7313 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7314 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7315 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7316 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007317
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007318 Arguments:
7319 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007320
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007321 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7322 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007323
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007324http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007325
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007326 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7327 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7328 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007329
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007330http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7331
7332 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7333 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7334 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7335 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7336 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7337
7338http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7339
7340 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7341 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7342 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7343 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7344 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7345 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7346 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7347 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7348 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7349
7350http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7351
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007352 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7353 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7354 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7355 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace.
7356 It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7357 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7358 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007359 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7360 and OpenBSD.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007361
7362http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7363
7364 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7365 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7366 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7367 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7368 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7369 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7370 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7371 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7372
7373http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7374 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7375
7376 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7377 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7378 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7379 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007380
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007381 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007382 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7383 http-response set-status 431
7384 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7385 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007386
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007387http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007388
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007389 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7390 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7391 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7392 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7393 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7394 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7395 based on some information from the request.
7396
7397 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7398
7399http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007400http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007401
7402 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7403 inline.
7404
7405 Arguments:
7406 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7407 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7408 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7409 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7410 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7411 (request and response)
7412 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7413 processing
7414 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7415 processing
7416 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7417 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7418 and '_'.
7419
7420 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7421 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007422
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007423 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
7424 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
7425
7426 Examples:
7427 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
7428 http-response set-var-fmt(sess.last_be_addr) %[bi]:%[bp]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007429
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007430http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007431
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007432 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7433 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7434 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7435 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7436 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7437 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7438 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7439 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7440 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7441 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7442 action.
7443 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7444 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7445 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7446 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7447 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007448
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007449http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7450
7451 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7452 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7453 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7454 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7455 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007456 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007457 processing.
7458
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007459 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007460 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007461 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007462 rules evaluation.
7463
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007464http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7465http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7466http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007467
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007468 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7469 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7470 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7471 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7472 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007473 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007474
7475http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7476
7477 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7478 about <var-name>.
7479
7480 Example:
7481 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7482
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007483http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7484 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7485
7486 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7487 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7488 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7489 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7490 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7491 buffer is full.
7492
7493 Arguments :
7494
7495 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7496 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7497
7498 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007499 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007500 bytes.
7501
7502 Example:
7503 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007504
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007505http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7506 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7507
7508 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7509 yes | no | yes | yes
7510
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007511 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007512 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7513 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7514 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007515
7516 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7517
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007518 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7519 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7520 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7521 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7522 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7523 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7524 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007525 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007526 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7527 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007528
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007529 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7530 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7531 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7532 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7533 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7534 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7535 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007536 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7537 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7538 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7539 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7540 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7541 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007542
7543 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7544 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7545 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7546 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7547 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7548 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7549 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7550 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007551 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007552 downsides of rare connection failures.
7553
7554 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7555 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7556 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7557 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7558 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7559 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007560 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007561 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7562 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7563 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7564 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7565 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7566
7567 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007568 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7569 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7570 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7571 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007572
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007573 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7574 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007575
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007576 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007577
7578 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7579 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7580 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7581
7582 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7583
7584
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007585http-send-name-header [<header>]
7586 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007587 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7588 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007589 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007590 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7591
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007592 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7593 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7594 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7595 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7596 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7597 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7598 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7599 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7600 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7601 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7602 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7603 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7604 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7605 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7606 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7607 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007608
7609 See also : "server"
7610
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007611id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007612 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7614 no | yes | yes | yes
7615 Arguments : none
7616
7617 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7618 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7619 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007620
7621
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007622ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7623 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7624 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007625 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007626
7627 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7628 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7629 and running).
7630
7631 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7632 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7633 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007634 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007635 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7636
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007637 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7638 "unless" condition is met.
7639
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007640 Example:
7641 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7642 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7643 ignore-persist if url_static
7644
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007645 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7646
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007647load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7648 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7649 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7650 yes | no | yes | yes
7651
7652 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7653 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7654 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007655 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007656 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007657 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7658 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7659 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7660
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007661 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007662 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007663 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007664
7665 Arguments:
7666 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7667 named "server-state-file".
7668
7669 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7670 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7671 name is used as a file name.
7672
7673 none don't load any stat for this backend
7674
7675 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007676 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7677 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7678 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007679 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007680 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007681
7682 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7683 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7684
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007685 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007686
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007687 global
7688 stats socket /tmp/socket
7689 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007690
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007691 defaults
7692 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007693
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007694 backend bk
7695 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7696 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007697
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007698
7699 Then one can run :
7700
7701 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7702
7703 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7704
7705 1
7706 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7707 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7708 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7709
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007710 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007711
7712 global
7713 stats socket /tmp/socket
7714 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7715
7716 defaults
7717 load-server-state-from-file local
7718
7719 backend bk
7720 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7721 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7722
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007723
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007724 Then one can run :
7725
7726 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7727
7728 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7729
7730 1
7731 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7732 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7733 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7734
7735 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7736 "show servers state"
7737
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007738
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007739log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007740log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007741 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007742no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007743 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7745 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007746
7747 Prefix :
7748 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7749 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7750 prefix does not allow arguments.
7751
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007752 Arguments :
7753 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7754 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7755 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7756 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7757 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7758 parameter.
7759
7760 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7761 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7762
7763 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7764 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7765 standard syslog port).
7766
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007767 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7768 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7769 standard syslog port).
7770
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007771 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7772 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7773 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007774 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007775
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007776 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7777 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7778 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7779 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7780 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7781 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7782 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7783 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7784 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7785 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7786 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7787 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007788 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007789 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7790 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7791 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007792 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7793 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007794
7795 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7796 and "fd@2", see above.
7797
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007798 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7799 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7800 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7801 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7802 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7803 having the logs instantly available.
7804
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007805 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7806 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7807 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7808
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007809 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7810 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007811
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007812 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7813 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7814 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7815 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7816 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7817 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7818 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7819 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7820 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7821 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007822 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007823
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007824 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7825 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7826 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7827 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7828 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7829
7830 <sample_size>
7831 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7832 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7833 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7834 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7835 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7836
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007837 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7838 one of the following :
7839
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007840 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7841 field is stripped. This is the default.
7842 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7843 rfc3164.
7844
7845 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007846 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7847
7848 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7849 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7850
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007851 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7852 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7853 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7854 designed to be used with a local log server.
7855
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007856 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7857 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7858 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7859 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7860 systemd logger consumes.
7861
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007862 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7863 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7864 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7865 used with a local log server.
7866
7867 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7868 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7869 designed to be used with a local log server.
7870
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007871 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7872 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7873 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7874 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7875
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007876 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7877
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007878 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7879 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7880 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7881
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007882 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7883 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7884 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7885 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007886
7887 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7888 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7889 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007890 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7891 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7892 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7893 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7894 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007895
7896 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7897
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007898 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7899 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7900 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007901
7902 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7903 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7904 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7905 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7906
7907 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7908 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007909
7910 Example :
7911 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007912 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7913 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7914 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007915 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007916 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7917 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007918 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007919
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007920
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007921log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007922 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7923 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7924 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007925
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007926 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7927 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7928 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7929 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7930 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02007931 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
7932 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007933
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02007934 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
7935 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007936
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007937log-format-sd <string>
7938 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7939 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7940 yes | yes | yes | no
7941
7942 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7943 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7944 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7945 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7946 which covers the log format string in depth.
7947
7948 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7949 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7950
7951 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7952 log format to "rfc5424".
7953
7954 Example :
7955 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7956
7957
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007958log-tag <string>
7959 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7960 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7961 yes | yes | yes | yes
7962
7963 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7964 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007965 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007966 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7967 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7968 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7969 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7970 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7971 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007972
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007973max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7974 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7975 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7976 yes | no | yes | yes
7977
7978 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7979 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7980 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7981 servers.
7982
7983 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007984 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007985 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7986 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7987 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007988 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007989 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7990 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7991 picking a different server.
7992
7993 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7994 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7995 even if they have to be queued.
7996
7997 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7998 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7999
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008000max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8001 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8002 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8003 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008004
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008005maxconn <conns>
8006 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8008 yes | yes | yes | no
8009 Arguments :
8010 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8011 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8012 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8013 closes.
8014
8015 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008016 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008017 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8018 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008019 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8020 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8021 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8022 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008023
8024 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8025 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8026 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8027
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008028 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8029 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008030
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008031 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8032
8033
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008034mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008035 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8037 yes | yes | yes | yes
8038 Arguments :
8039 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8040 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8041 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8042 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8043
8044 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8045 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8046 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8047 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8048 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8049
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008050 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8051 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8052 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008053
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008054 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008055 defaults http_instances
8056 mode http
8057
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008058
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008059monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008060 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8062 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008063 Arguments :
8064 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8065 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008066 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008067 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8068 backend and its backup.
8069
8070 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8071 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8072 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8073 servers in a list of backends.
8074
8075 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8076 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8077 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008078 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008079 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8080 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008081 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008082 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8083 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008084
8085 Example:
8086 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008087 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008088 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8089 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8090 monitor-uri /site_alive
8091 monitor fail if site_dead
8092
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008093 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008094
8095
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008096monitor-uri <uri>
8097 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8099 yes | yes | yes | no
8100 Arguments :
8101 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8102 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8103
8104 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8105 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8106 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8107 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8108 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8109 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8110 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8111 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8112
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008113 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008114 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8115 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8116 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8117 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8118 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8119 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008120
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008121 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8122 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8123 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8124 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8125
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008126 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008127 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008128 frontend www
8129 mode http
8130 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8131
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008132 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008133
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008134
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008135option abortonclose
8136no option abortonclose
8137 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8139 yes | no | yes | yes
8140 Arguments : none
8141
8142 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8143 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8144 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8145 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008146 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008147 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8148 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8149 encountered while delivering the response.
8150
8151 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8152 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8153 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8154 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8155 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8156 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008157 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008158 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008159 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008160 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8161 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8162 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8163
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008164 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8165 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008166 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8167 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8168 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8169 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8170 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8171 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008172 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008173
8174 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8175 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8176
8177 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8178
8179
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008180option accept-invalid-http-request
8181no option accept-invalid-http-request
8182 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8184 yes | yes | yes | no
8185 Arguments : none
8186
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008187 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008188 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008189 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008190 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8191 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8192 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8193 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8194 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008195 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8196 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8197 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8198 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008199 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008200 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008201 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8202 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8203 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008204
8205 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8206 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8207 been confirmed.
8208
8209 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8210 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008211 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8212 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008213 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8214
8215 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8216 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8217
8218 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8219 stats socket.
8220
8221
8222option accept-invalid-http-response
8223no option accept-invalid-http-response
8224 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8226 yes | no | yes | yes
8227 Arguments : none
8228
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008229 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008230 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008231 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008232 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8233 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8234 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8235 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8236 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008237 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8238 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8239 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008240
8241 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8242 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8243 been confirmed.
8244
8245 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8246 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8247 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8248 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8249
8250 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8251 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8252
8253 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8254 stats socket.
8255
8256
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008257option allbackups
8258no option allbackups
8259 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8261 yes | no | yes | yes
8262 Arguments : none
8263
8264 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8265 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8266 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8267 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8268 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8269 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8270 order between the backup servers anymore.
8271
8272 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8273 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8274
8275 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8276 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8277
8278
8279option checkcache
8280no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008281 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8283 yes | no | yes | yes
8284 Arguments : none
8285
8286 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8287 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008288 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008289 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8290 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008291 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008292
8293 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008294 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008295 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008296 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8297 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008298 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008299 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008300 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8301 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008302 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008303 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8304 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008305 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008306 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8307 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8308 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8309 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8310 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8311 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8312 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8313 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8314 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8315
8316 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008317 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8318 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8319 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8320 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008321
8322 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8323 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008324 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008325 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008326
8327 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8328 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8329
8330
8331option clitcpka
8332no option clitcpka
8333 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8335 yes | yes | yes | no
8336 Arguments : none
8337
8338 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8339 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008340 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008341 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8342
8343 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8344 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8345 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8346 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8347
8348 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8349 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8350 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8351 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8352 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8353
8354 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8355
8356 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8357 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8358 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8359
8360 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8361 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8362
8363 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8364
8365
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008366option contstats
8367 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8369 yes | yes | yes | no
8370 Arguments : none
8371
8372 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8373 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8374 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008375 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008376 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8377 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8378 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8379 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8380 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008381
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008382option disable-h2-upgrade
8383no option disable-h2-upgrade
8384 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8385 connection.
8386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8387 yes | yes | yes | no
8388 Arguments : none
8389
8390 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8391 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8392 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8393 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008394 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8395 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8396 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8397 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8398 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8399 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008400
8401 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8402 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008403
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008404option dontlog-normal
8405no option dontlog-normal
8406 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8408 yes | yes | yes | no
8409 Arguments : none
8410
8411 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8412 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8413 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8414 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8415 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8416 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8417 logged.
8418
8419 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8420 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8421 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008423 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008424 logging.
8425
8426
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008427option dontlognull
8428no option dontlognull
8429 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8431 yes | yes | yes | no
8432 Arguments : none
8433
8434 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8435 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8436 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8437 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8438 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8439 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008440 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8441 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8442 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008443
8444 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008445 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008446 would not be logged.
8447
8448 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8449 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8450
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008451 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008452 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008453
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008454
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008455option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008456 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8458 yes | yes | yes | yes
8459 Arguments :
8460 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8461 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008462 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008463 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008464
8465 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8466 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8467 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8468 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8469 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8470 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8471 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008472 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8473 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8474 possible that the client has already brought one.
8475
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008476 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008477 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008478 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008479 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008480 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008481 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008482
8483 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8484 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8485 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8486 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8487 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8488 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008489 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008490
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008491 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8492 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008493 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008494 are under the control of the end-user.
8495
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008496 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008497 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8498 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008499 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8500 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8501 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008502
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008503 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008504 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8505 frontend www
8506 mode http
8507 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8508
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008509 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8510 backend www
8511 mode http
8512 option forwardfor header X-Client
8513
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008514 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008515 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008516
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008517
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008518option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8519no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8520 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8522 yes | yes | yes | no
8523 Arguments : none
8524
8525 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8526 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8527 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8528 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8529 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8530 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8531 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8532
8533 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8534 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8535 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8536 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8537 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8538 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8539 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8540 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8541 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8542 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8543
8544 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8545
8546 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8547 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8548
8549 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8550 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8551
8552
8553option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8554no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8555 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8557 yes | no | yes | yes
8558 Arguments : none
8559
8560 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8561 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8562 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8563 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8564 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8565 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8566 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8567
8568 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8569 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8570 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8571 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8572 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8573 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8574 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8575 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8576 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8577 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8578
8579 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8580
8581 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8582 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8583
8584 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8585 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8586
8587
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008588option http-buffer-request
8589no option http-buffer-request
8590 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8592 yes | yes | yes | yes
8593 Arguments : none
8594
8595 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8596 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8597 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8598 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8599 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8600 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008601 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8602 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8603 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8604 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008605
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008606 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8607 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008608
8609
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008610option http-ignore-probes
8611no option http-ignore-probes
8612 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8614 yes | yes | yes | no
8615 Arguments : none
8616
8617 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8618 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8619 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8620 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8621 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8622 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8623 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8624 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8625 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008626 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8627 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008628 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8629
8630 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8631 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8632 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8633 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8634 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8635 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8636 are often the only way to detect them.
8637
8638 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8639 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8640
8641 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8642
8643
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008644option http-keep-alive
8645no option http-keep-alive
8646 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8648 yes | yes | yes | yes
8649 Arguments : none
8650
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008651 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8652 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008653 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8654 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008655 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8656 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8657 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008658
8659 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8660 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008661 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8662 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8663 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8664 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8665 situations where this option may be useful :
8666
8667 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008668 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008669
8670 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8671 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8672
8673 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8674 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8675 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8676 request.
8677
8678 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8679 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008680 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8681 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8682 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008683
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008684 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8685 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8686 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8687 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8688 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8689 not set.
8690
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008691 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8692 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8693 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008694
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008695 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008696 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008697 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008698
8699
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008700option http-no-delay
8701no option http-no-delay
8702 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8704 yes | yes | yes | yes
8705 Arguments : none
8706
8707 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8708 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8709 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8710 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8711 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8712 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8713 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008714 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008715 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8716 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8717 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8718 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8719 affected.
8720
8721 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8722 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8723 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8724 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8725 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8726 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8727 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8728 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8729 latency environments.
8730
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008731 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8732
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008733
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008734option http-pretend-keepalive
8735no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008736 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008738 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008739 Arguments : none
8740
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008741 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008742 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8743 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8744 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008745 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008746 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8747 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8748 consider the response complete.
8749
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008750 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008751 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008752 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008753 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008754 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008755 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8756
8757 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8758 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8759 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8760 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008761 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8762 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008763 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8764
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008765 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8766 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8767 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8768 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8769 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8770 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008771
8772 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8773 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8774
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008775 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008776 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008777
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008778
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008779option http-server-close
8780no option http-server-close
8781 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8783 yes | yes | yes | yes
8784 Arguments : none
8785
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008786 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8787 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8788 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8789 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008790 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8791 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8792 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8793 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8794 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8795 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8796 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8797 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8798 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8799 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8800 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008801
8802 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8803 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8804 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8805 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008806 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8807 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008808
8809 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8810 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008811 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8812 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8813 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008814
8815 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8816 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8817
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008818 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8819 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008820
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008821option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008822no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008823 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8825 yes | yes | yes | no
8826 Arguments : none
8827
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008828 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008829 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8830 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8831 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8832 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8833 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008834 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008835
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008836 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008837 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008838 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8839 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8840 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008841
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008842 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8843 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8844 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8845 front of an existing proxy.
8846
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008847 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8848
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008849 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008850
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008851option httpchk
8852option httpchk <uri>
8853option httpchk <method> <uri>
8854option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008855 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8857 yes | no | yes | yes
8858 Arguments :
8859 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8860 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8861 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8862 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8863 ones.
8864
8865 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8866 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8867 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8868
8869 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8870 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8871 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008872 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008873
8874 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8875 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8876 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8877 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8878 the lack of any response.
8879
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008880 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8881 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8882 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8883 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8884
8885 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8886 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8887 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008888
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008889 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8890 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008891 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008892 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008893 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008894
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008895 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8896 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8897 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8898 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8899
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008900 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008901 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8902 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8903 backend https_relay
8904 mode tcp
8905 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8906 http-check send hdr Host www
8907 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008908
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008909 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8910 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8911 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008912
8913
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008914option httpclose
8915no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008916 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8918 yes | yes | yes | yes
8919 Arguments : none
8920
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008921 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8922 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8923 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8924 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008925 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008926
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008927 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8928 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008929 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008930 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8931 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008932
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008933 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8934 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8935 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008936
8937 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8938 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008939 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8940 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8941 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008942
8943 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8944 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8945
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008946 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008947
8948
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008949option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008950 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008952 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008953 Arguments :
8954 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8955 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8956 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008957 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008958 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008959
8960 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8961 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8962 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8963 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8964 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8965 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8966 ports.
8967
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008968 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8969 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008970
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008971 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008973 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008974
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008975option httpslog
8976 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
8977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8978 yes | yes | yes | no
8979
8980 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8981 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8982 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8983 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8984 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8985 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
8986 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
8987
8988 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8989
8990 See also : section 8 about logging.
8991
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008992
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008993option independent-streams
8994no option independent-streams
8995 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8997 yes | yes | yes | yes
8998 Arguments : none
8999
9000 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9001 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9002 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9003 receive data or not.
9004
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009005 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009006 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9007 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9008 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9009 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9010 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9011 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9012 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9013 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9014 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9015 socket buffers.
9016
9017 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9018 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9019 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9020 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9021 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9022
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009023 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009024
9025
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009026option ldap-check
9027 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9029 yes | no | yes | yes
9030 Arguments : none
9031
9032 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9033 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9034 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9035 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9036
9037 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9038 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9039
9040 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9041 configure it.
9042
9043 Example :
9044 option ldap-check
9045
9046 See also : "option httpchk"
9047
9048
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009049option external-check
9050 Use external processes for server health checks
9051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9052 yes | no | yes | yes
9053
9054 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9055 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9056 command".
9057
9058 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9059
9060 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9061
9062
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009063option log-health-checks
9064no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009065 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9067 yes | no | yes | yes
9068 Arguments : none
9069
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009070 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9071 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9072 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009073
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009074 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9075 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9076 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9077 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9078 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9079
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009080 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009081 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009082
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009083 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9084 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9085 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009086
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009087
9088option log-separate-errors
9089no option log-separate-errors
9090 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9092 yes | yes | yes | no
9093 Arguments : none
9094
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009095 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009096 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9097 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9098 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9099 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9100 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9101 provides very important information.
9102
9103 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9104 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9105 error logs.
9106
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009107 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009108 logging.
9109
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009110
9111option logasap
9112no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009113 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9115 yes | yes | yes | no
9116 Arguments : none
9117
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009118 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9119 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9120 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9121 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9122
9123 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9124 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9125 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9126 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9127 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009128 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009129 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9130 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9131 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9132 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009133 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009134
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009135 Examples :
9136 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9137 mode http
9138 option httplog
9139 option logasap
9140 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9141
9142 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9143 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9144 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9145 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9146
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009147 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009148 logging.
9149
9150
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009151option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009152 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9154 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009155 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009156 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9157 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009158 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9159 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009160
9161 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9162 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009163 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009164 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009165 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9166 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9167 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009168
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009169 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9170 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9171 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009172
9173 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009174 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009175 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9176 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9177 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9178 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9179 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9180 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9181 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9182
9183 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9184 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009185
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009186 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009187
9188 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9189 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9190 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9191 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009192 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009193 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009194
9195 See also: "option httpchk"
9196
9197
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009198option nolinger
9199no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009200 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009201 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9202 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009203 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009204
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009205 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009206 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9207 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9208 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9209 connections.
9210
9211 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9212 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009213 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9214 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9215 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9216 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9217 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9218 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9219 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9220 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9221 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9222 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9223 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9224 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9225 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009226
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009227 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9228 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9229 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9230 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9231 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009232
9233 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9234 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009235 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009236 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009237 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009238
9239 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9240 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9241
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009242 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9243 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009244
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009245option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9246 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9248 yes | yes | yes | yes
9249 Arguments :
9250 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9251 matching <network>
9252 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9253 header name.
9254
9255 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9256 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9257 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9258 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9259 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9260 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9261 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9262 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9263 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9264 possible that the client has already brought one.
9265
9266 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9267 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9268 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9269 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9270 header and requires different one.
9271
9272 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9273 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9274 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009275 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9276 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9277 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9278 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9279 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009280
9281 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9282 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9283 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9284 both are defined.
9285
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009286 Examples :
9287 # Original Destination address
9288 frontend www
9289 mode http
9290 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9291
9292 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9293 backend www
9294 mode http
9295 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9296
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009297 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009298
9299
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009300option persist
9301no option persist
9302 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9303 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9304 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009305 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009306
9307 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9308 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9309 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9310 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9311 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9312 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9313 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9314 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9315 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9316 redirected to another valid server.
9317
9318 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9319 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9320
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009321 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009322
9323
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009324option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9325 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9327 yes | no | yes | yes
9328 Arguments :
9329 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9330 PostgreSQL server.
9331
9332 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9333 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9334 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9335 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9336
9337 See also: "option httpchk"
9338
9339
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009340option prefer-last-server
9341no option prefer-last-server
9342 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9343 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9344 yes | no | yes | yes
9345 Arguments : none
9346
9347 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009348 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009349 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9350 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009351 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009352 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009353 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009354 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9355 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009356 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009357 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009358 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9359 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9360 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009361 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9362 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9363 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009364
9365 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9366 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9367
9368 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9369
9370
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009371option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009372option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009373no option redispatch
9374 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9375 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9376 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009377 Arguments :
9378 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9379 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9380 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009381 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009382 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009383 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009384 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9385 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9386 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9387
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009388
9389 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9390 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9391 be able to access the service anymore.
9392
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009393 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9394 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009395
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009396 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9397 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9398 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9399 following order:
9400
9401 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9402
9403 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9404 list, or
9405
9406 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9407
9408 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9409 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9410
9411 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9412 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9413 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9414 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9415
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009416 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009417 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9418 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009419
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009420 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9421 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9422
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009423 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009424
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009425
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009426option redis-check
9427 Use redis health checks for server testing
9428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9429 yes | no | yes | yes
9430 Arguments : none
9431
9432 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9433 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9434 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9435 find the "+PONG" response message.
9436
9437 Example :
9438 option redis-check
9439
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009440 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009441
9442
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009443option smtpchk
9444option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9445 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9447 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009448 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009449 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009450 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009451 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9452
9453 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9454 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9455 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9456
9457 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9458 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9459 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9460 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9461 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9462 dead server.
9463
9464 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9465 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009466 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009467 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9468
9469 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9470 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9471 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9472 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009473 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009474
9475 Example :
9476 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9477
9478 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9479
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009480
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009481option socket-stats
9482no option socket-stats
9483
9484 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9486 yes | yes | yes | no
9487
9488 Arguments : none
9489
9490
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009491option splice-auto
9492no option splice-auto
9493 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9495 yes | yes | yes | yes
9496 Arguments : none
9497
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009498 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009499 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009500 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009501 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009502 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009503 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9504 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9505 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9506 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9507
9508 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9509 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9510 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9511 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9512 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9513 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9514 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9515 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9516 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9517 keyword.
9518
9519 Example :
9520 option splice-auto
9521
9522 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9523 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9524
9525 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9526 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9527
9528
9529option splice-request
9530no option splice-request
9531 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9533 yes | yes | yes | yes
9534 Arguments : none
9535
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009536 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009537 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009538 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9539 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9540 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9541 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9542
9543 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9544
9545 Example :
9546 option splice-request
9547
9548 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9549 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9550
9551 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9552 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9553
9554
9555option splice-response
9556no option splice-response
9557 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9559 yes | yes | yes | yes
9560 Arguments : none
9561
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009562 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009563 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009564 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9565 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9566 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9567 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9568
9569 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9570
9571 Example :
9572 option splice-response
9573
9574 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9575 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9576
9577 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9578 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9579
9580
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009581option spop-check
9582 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9584 no | no | no | yes
9585 Arguments : none
9586
9587 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9588 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9589 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9590 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9591
9592 Example :
9593 option spop-check
9594
9595 See also : "option httpchk"
9596
9597
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009598option srvtcpka
9599no option srvtcpka
9600 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9602 yes | no | yes | yes
9603 Arguments : none
9604
9605 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9606 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009607 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009608 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9609
9610 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9611 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9612 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9613 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9614
9615 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9616 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9617 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9618 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9619 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9620
9621 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9622
9623 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9624 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9625 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9626
9627 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9628 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9629
9630 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9631
9632
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009633option ssl-hello-chk
9634 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9636 yes | no | yes | yes
9637 Arguments : none
9638
9639 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9640 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9641 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9642 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9643 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9644 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9645 hello message.
9646
9647 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9648 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9649 messages, which is appreciable.
9650
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009651 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009652 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9653 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009654
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009655 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9656
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009657
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009658option tcp-check
9659 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9660 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9661 yes | no | yes | yes
9662
9663 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9664 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9665
9666 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9667 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9668 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9669
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009670 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009671 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9672 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9673 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9674 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9675 only.
9676
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009677 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009678 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009679 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9680 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9681 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9682
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009683 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009684 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9685 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009686 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009687 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9688 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9689 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9690 the respective protocols.
9691 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009692 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009693
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009694 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009695
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009696 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9697 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9698 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9699 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009700
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009701 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9702 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9703 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009704
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009705
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009706 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009707 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009708 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009709 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009710
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009711 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009712 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009713 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009714
9715 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9716 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009717 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009718 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009719 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009720 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009721 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009722 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009723 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9724 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009725 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009726 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9727 tcp-check expect string +OK
9728
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009729 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009730 (send many headers before analyzing)
9731 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009732 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009733 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9734 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9735 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9736 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009737 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009738
9739
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009740 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009741
9742
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009743option tcp-smart-accept
9744no option tcp-smart-accept
9745 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9747 yes | yes | yes | no
9748 Arguments : none
9749
9750 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9751 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9752 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9753 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9754 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9755 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9756
9757 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9758 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9759 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9760 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9761
9762 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9763 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9764 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009765 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009766
9767 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9768 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9769 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9770
9771 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9772 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9773 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9774
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009775 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9776
9777
9778option tcp-smart-connect
9779no option tcp-smart-connect
9780 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9782 yes | no | yes | yes
9783 Arguments : none
9784
9785 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9786 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9787 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9788 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9789 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9790
9791 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9792 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9793 complex.
9794
9795 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9796 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9797 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9798
9799 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9800 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9801
9802 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9803
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009804
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009805option tcpka
9806 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9808 yes | yes | yes | yes
9809 Arguments : none
9810
9811 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9812 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009813 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009814 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9815
9816 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9817 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9818 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9819 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9820
9821 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9822 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9823 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9824 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9825 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9826
9827 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9828
9829 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9830 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9831 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9832 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9833 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9834 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9835 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9836 backends.
9837
9838 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9839
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009840
9841option tcplog
9842 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009844 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009845 Arguments : none
9846
9847 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9848 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9849 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9850 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9851 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9852 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9853 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9854 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9855
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009856 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9857
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009858 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009859
9860
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009861option transparent
9862no option transparent
9863 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009865 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009866 Arguments : none
9867
9868 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9869 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9870 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9871 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9872 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9873 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9874 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9875 appropriate server.
9876
9877 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9878 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9879
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009880 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009881 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009882
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009883
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009884external-check command <command>
9885 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9887 yes | no | yes | yes
9888
9889 Arguments :
9890 <command> is the external command to run
9891
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009892 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9893
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009894 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009895
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009896 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9897 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9898 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9899 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9900 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9901 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009902
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009903 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9904
9905 Environment variables :
9906 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9907 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9908
9909 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9910
9911 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9912
9913 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9914 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9915 for a UNIX socket).
9916
9917 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9918
9919 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9920
9921 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9922
9923 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9924
9925 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9926
9927 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9928 socket).
9929
9930 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9931 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9932
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009933 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9934
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009935 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9936 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9937 failed.
9938
9939 Example :
9940 external-check command /bin/true
9941
9942 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9943
9944
9945external-check path <path>
9946 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9948 yes | no | yes | yes
9949
9950 Arguments :
9951 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9952
9953 The default path is "".
9954
9955 Example :
9956 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9957
9958 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9959 "external-check command"
9960
9961
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009962persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009963persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009964 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9966 yes | no | yes | yes
9967 Arguments :
9968 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009969 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9970 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009971
9972 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9973 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009974 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009975 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9976 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9977 forwarded to this server.
9978
9979 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9980 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9981 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009982 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009983 a single "listen" section.
9984
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009985 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9986 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9987 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9988
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009989 Example :
9990 listen tse-farm
9991 bind :3389
9992 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9993 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9994 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9995 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9996 persist rdp-cookie
9997 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009998 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009999 balance rdp-cookie
10000 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10001 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10002
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +090010003 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
10004 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010005
10006
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010007rate-limit sessions <rate>
10008 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10010 yes | yes | yes | no
10011 Arguments :
10012 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10013 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10014
10015 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10016 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10017 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010018 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010019 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10020 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10021
10022 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10023 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10024 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10025 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10026
10027 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10028 listen smtp
10029 mode tcp
10030 bind :25
10031 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010032 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010033
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010034 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10035 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10036 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010037
10038 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10039
10040
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010041redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10042redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10043redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010044 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10046 no | yes | yes | yes
10047
10048 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010049 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010050
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010051 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010052 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010053 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10054 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10055 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010056
10057 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10058 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10059 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10060 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10061 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010062 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10063 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10064 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10065 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010066
10067 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10068 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10069 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10070 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10071 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10072 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010073 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010074 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010075 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10076 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10077 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010078
10079 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010080 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10081 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10082 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010083 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010084 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10085 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10086 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10087 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010088
10089 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010090 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010091
10092 - "drop-query"
10093 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10094 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10095 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10096 with a location-type redirect.
10097
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010098 - "append-slash"
10099 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10100 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10101 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10102 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10103
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010104 - "ignore-empty"
10105 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10106 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10107 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10108 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10109 of known paths using a simple map.
10110
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010111 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10112 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10113 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10114 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10115 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10116 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10117 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10118
10119 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10120 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10121 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10122 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10123 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10124 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10125 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010126
10127 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10128 acl clear dst_port 80
10129 acl secure dst_port 8080
10130 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010131 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010132 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010133 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10134
10135 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010136 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10137 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10138 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010139 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010140
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010141 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10142 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10143 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10144
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010145 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010146 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010147
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010148 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010149 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10150 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10151 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010152
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010153 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
10154 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10155 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
10156
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010157 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010158
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010159
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010160retries <value>
10161 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10162 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10163 yes | no | yes | yes
10164 Arguments :
10165 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10166 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10167 default value is 3.
10168
10169 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10170 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10171 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10172
10173 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010174 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10175 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010176
10177 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10178 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10179
10180 See also : "option redispatch"
10181
10182
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010183retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010184 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10185 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10186 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010187 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10188 yes | no | yes | yes
10189 Arguments :
10190 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10191 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10192 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10193 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10194
10195 none never retry
10196
10197 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10198 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10199
10200 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10201 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10202 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10203 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10204 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10205 processing the request.
10206
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010207 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10208 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10209 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10210 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10211 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10212 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10213 overflow attack for example).
10214
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010215 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10216 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10217 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10218 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10219 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10220 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10221 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10222 amplify denial of service attacks.
10223
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010224 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10225 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10226 considered to be safe to retry.
10227
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010228 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10229 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10230 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10231 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10232 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010233
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010234 all-retryable-errors
10235 retry request for any error that are considered
10236 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10237 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10238 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10239
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010240 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10241 not cumulative.
10242
10243 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10244 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10245 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10246 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10247
10248 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10249 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10250 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10251 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10252 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10253 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10254 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10255 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10256 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10257 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10258 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10259 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10260
10261 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10262 should not use this directive.
10263
10264 The default is "conn-failure".
10265
10266 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10267
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010268server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010269 Declare a server in a backend
10270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10271 no | no | yes | yes
10272 Arguments :
10273 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010274 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010275 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010276
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010277 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10278 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10279 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10280 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010281 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10282 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010283 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010284 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10285 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010286 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10287 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10288 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10289 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10290 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10291 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10292 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010293 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010294 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10295 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10296 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10297 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10298 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10299 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010300 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10301 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010302 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10303 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010304
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010305 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010306 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10307 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10308 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10309 adding this value to the client's port.
10310
10311 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10312 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010313 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010314
10315 Examples :
10316 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10317 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010318 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010319 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10320 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10321 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010322
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010323 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10324 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10325 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10326 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10327 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10328
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010329 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10330 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010331
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010332server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010333 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010334 this backend.
10335 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10336 no | no | yes | yes
10337
10338 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10339 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10340 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10341 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10342 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010343
10344 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10345 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10346
10347 global
10348 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10349
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010350 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010351 load-server-state-from-file
10352
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010353 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010354 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010355
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010356server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10357 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10358 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10360 no | no | yes | yes
10361
10362 Arguments:
10363 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10364
10365 <num | range>
10366 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10367 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10368 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10369 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10370
10371 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10372
10373 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10374
10375 <params*>
10376 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10377 keyword.
10378
10379 Examples:
10380 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10381 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10382 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10383
10384 # or
10385 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10386
10387 # would be equivalent to:
10388 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10389 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10390 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10391
10392
10393
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010394source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010395source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010396source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010397 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10399 yes | no | yes | yes
10400 Arguments :
10401 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10402 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010403
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010404 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010405 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10406 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10407 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10408 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10409 supported prefixes are :
10410 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10411 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10412 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010413 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010414 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10415 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010416
10417 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10418 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010419 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10420 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10421 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010422
10423 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10424 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10425 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10426 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10427 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10428 <addr>.
10429
10430 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10431 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10432 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10433 port.
10434
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010435 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10436 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10437 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10438 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010439 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010440 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10441 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10442 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10443 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10444 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10445 HTTP header.
10446
10447 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10448 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010449 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010450 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10451 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10452 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10453 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10454 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10455 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10456 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10457
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010458 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10459 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10460 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10461 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10462 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10463 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10464
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010465 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10466 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10467 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10468 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10469
10470 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10471 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10472 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10473 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10474 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10475 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10476
10477 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10478 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10479 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10480 there are two methods :
10481
10482 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10483 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10484 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10485 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10486 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10487 of the client ranges may be used.
10488
10489 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10490 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10491 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10492 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10493 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10494 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10495 same session.
10496
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010497 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10498 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10499 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010500 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010501
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010502 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10503
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010504 Examples :
10505 backend private
10506 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10507 source 192.168.1.200
10508
10509 backend transparent_ssl1
10510 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10511 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10512
10513 backend transparent_ssl2
10514 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10515 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10516 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10517
10518 backend transparent_ssl3
10519 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10520 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10521 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10522
10523 backend transparent_smtp
10524 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10525 # with Tproxy version 4.
10526 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10527
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010528 backend transparent_http
10529 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10530 # proxy.
10531 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010533 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010534 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10535
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010536
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010537srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10538 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10539 the connection on the server side.
10540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10541 yes | no | yes | yes
10542 Arguments :
10543 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10544
10545 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10546 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010547 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10548 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010549
10550 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10551
10552
10553srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10554 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10555 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10556 server side.
10557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10558 yes | no | yes | yes
10559 Arguments :
10560 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10561 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10562 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10563 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10564
10565 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10566 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010567 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10568 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010569
10570 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10571
10572
10573srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10574 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10576 yes | no | yes | yes
10577 Arguments :
10578 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10579 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10580 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10581 document.
10582
10583 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10584 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010585 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10586 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010587
10588 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10589
10590
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010591stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10592 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010594 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010595
10596 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10597 matched.
10598
10599 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10600 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10601
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010602 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10603 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10604 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10605 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010606
10607 Example :
10608 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10609 backend stats_localhost
10610 stats enable
10611 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10612
10613 Example :
10614 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10615 backend stats_auth
10616 stats enable
10617 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10618 stats admin if TRUE
10619
10620 Example :
10621 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10622 userlist stats-auth
10623 group admin users admin
10624 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10625 group readonly users haproxy
10626 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10627
10628 backend stats_auth
10629 stats enable
10630 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10631 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10632 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10633 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10634
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020010635 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
10636 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010637
10638
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010639stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10640 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010642 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010643 Arguments :
10644 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10645
10646 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10647
10648 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10649 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10650 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10651 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10652 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10653 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10654
10655 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10656 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10657 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010658 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010659
10660 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10661 report using "stats scope".
10662
10663 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10664 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10665 unobvious parameters.
10666
10667 Example :
10668 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10669 backend public_www
10670 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10671 stats enable
10672 stats hide-version
10673 stats scope .
10674 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010675 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010676 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10677 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10678
10679 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10680 backend private_monitoring
10681 stats enable
10682 stats uri /admin?stats
10683 stats refresh 5s
10684
10685 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10686
10687
10688stats enable
10689 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010691 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010692 Arguments : none
10693
10694 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10695 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10696 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10697 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10698 - stats auth : no authentication
10699 - stats scope : no restriction
10700
10701 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10702 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10703 unobvious parameters.
10704
10705 Example :
10706 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10707 backend public_www
10708 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10709 stats enable
10710 stats hide-version
10711 stats scope .
10712 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010713 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010714 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10715 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10716
10717 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10718 backend private_monitoring
10719 stats enable
10720 stats uri /admin?stats
10721 stats refresh 5s
10722
10723 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10724
10725
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010726stats hide-version
10727 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010729 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010730 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010731
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010732 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10733 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10734 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10735 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10736 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10737 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010738
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010739 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10740 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10741 unobvious parameters.
10742
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010743 Example :
10744 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10745 backend public_www
10746 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010747 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010748 stats hide-version
10749 stats scope .
10750 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010751 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010752 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10753 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010754
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010755 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10756 backend private_monitoring
10757 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010758 stats uri /admin?stats
10759 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010760
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010761 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010762
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010763
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010764stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10765 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10766 Access control for statistics
10767
10768 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10769 no | no | yes | yes
10770
10771 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10772 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10773 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10774 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10775 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10776 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10777
10778 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10779 instance.
10780
10781 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10782 about ACL usage.
10783
10784
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010785stats realm <realm>
10786 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010788 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010789 Arguments :
10790 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10791 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10792 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10793
10794 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10795 using a backslash ('\').
10796
10797 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10798 only related to authentication.
10799
10800 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10801 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10802 unobvious parameters.
10803
10804 Example :
10805 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10806 backend public_www
10807 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10808 stats enable
10809 stats hide-version
10810 stats scope .
10811 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010812 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010813 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10814 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10815
10816 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10817 backend private_monitoring
10818 stats enable
10819 stats uri /admin?stats
10820 stats refresh 5s
10821
10822 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10823
10824
10825stats refresh <delay>
10826 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010828 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010829 Arguments :
10830 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10831 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10832 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10833 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10834 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10835 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10836
10837 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10838 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10839 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010840 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010841
10842 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10843 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10844 unobvious parameters.
10845
10846 Example :
10847 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10848 backend public_www
10849 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10850 stats enable
10851 stats hide-version
10852 stats scope .
10853 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010854 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010855 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10856 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10857
10858 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10859 backend private_monitoring
10860 stats enable
10861 stats uri /admin?stats
10862 stats refresh 5s
10863
10864 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10865
10866
10867stats scope { <name> | "." }
10868 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010870 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010871 Arguments :
10872 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10873 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10874 section in which the statement appears.
10875
10876 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10877 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10878 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10879 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10880 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10881 exists.
10882
10883 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10884 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10885 unobvious parameters.
10886
10887 Example :
10888 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10889 backend public_www
10890 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10891 stats enable
10892 stats hide-version
10893 stats scope .
10894 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010895 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010896 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10897 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10898
10899 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10900 backend private_monitoring
10901 stats enable
10902 stats uri /admin?stats
10903 stats refresh 5s
10904
10905 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10906
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010907
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010908stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010909 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010911 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010912
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010913 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010914 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10915
10916 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10917 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10918
10919 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10920 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010921 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010922
10923 Example :
10924 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10925 backend private_monitoring
10926 stats enable
10927 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10928 stats uri /admin?stats
10929 stats refresh 5s
10930
10931 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10932 global section.
10933
10934
10935stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010936 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10938 yes | yes | yes | yes
10939 Arguments : none
10940
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010941 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010942 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10943 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10944 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10945 - IP (socket, server)
10946 - cookie (backend, server)
10947
10948 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10949 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010950 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010951
10952 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10953
10954
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010955stats show-modules
10956 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10958 yes | yes | yes | yes
10959 Arguments : none
10960
10961 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10962 values as a tooltip.
10963
10964 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10965 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10966 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10967
10968 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10969
10970
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010971stats show-node [ <name> ]
10972 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010974 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010975 Arguments:
10976 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10977 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10978
10979 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10980 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010981 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010982
10983 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10984 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10985 unobvious parameters.
10986
10987 Example:
10988 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10989 backend private_monitoring
10990 stats enable
10991 stats show-node Europe-1
10992 stats uri /admin?stats
10993 stats refresh 5s
10994
10995 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10996 section.
10997
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010998
10999stats uri <prefix>
11000 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011002 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011003 Arguments :
11004 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11005 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11006 query string.
11007
11008 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11009 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11010 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11011 possible to reach it in the application.
11012
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011013 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011014 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011015 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11016 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11017 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11018 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11019
11020 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11021 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11022 an address or a port to statistics only.
11023
11024 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11025 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11026 unobvious parameters.
11027
11028 Example :
11029 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11030 backend public_www
11031 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11032 stats enable
11033 stats hide-version
11034 stats scope .
11035 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011036 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011037 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11038 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11039
11040 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11041 backend private_monitoring
11042 stats enable
11043 stats uri /admin?stats
11044 stats refresh 5s
11045
11046 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11047
11048
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011049stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11050 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011052 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011053
11054 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011055 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011056 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011057 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011058 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11059
11060 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11061 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11062 the "stick-table" statement.
11063
11064 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11065 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11066 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11067 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11068 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11069
11070 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11071 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11072 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11073 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11074 transformation rules.
11075
11076 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11077 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11078 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11079 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11080 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11081 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11082 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11083
11084 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11085 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11086 ACL based conditions.
11087
11088 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11089 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11090 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11091 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11092
11093 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11094 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11095 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11096 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11097
11098 Example :
11099 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11100 # last 30 minutes
11101 backend pop
11102 mode tcp
11103 balance roundrobin
11104 stick store-request src
11105 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11106 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11107 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11108
11109 backend smtp
11110 mode tcp
11111 balance roundrobin
11112 stick match src table pop
11113 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11114 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11115
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011116 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11117 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011118
11119
11120stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11121 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11123 no | no | yes | yes
11124
11125 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11126 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11127 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11128 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11129
11130 Examples :
11131 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011132 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011133
11134 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11135 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11136 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11137
11138
11139 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11140 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11141 backend http
11142 mode http
11143 balance roundrobin
11144 stick on src table https
11145 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11146 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11147 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11148
11149 backend https
11150 mode tcp
11151 balance roundrobin
11152 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11153 stick on src
11154 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11155 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11156
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011157 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011158
11159
11160stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11161 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11163 no | no | yes | yes
11164
11165 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011166 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011167 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011168 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011169 server is selected.
11170
11171 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11172 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11173 the "stick-table" statement.
11174
11175 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11176 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11177 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11178 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11179 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11180 address.
11181
11182 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11183 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11184 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11185 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11186 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11187 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11188 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11189 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11190 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11191 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11192
11193 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11194 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11195 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11196 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11197 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11198 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11199 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11200
11201 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11202 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11203 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11204 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11205
11206 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11207 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11208 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11209 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11210 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11211 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011212 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11213 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11214 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11215 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11216 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11217 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011218
11219 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11220 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11221 the request.
11222
11223 Example :
11224 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11225 # last 30 minutes
11226 backend pop
11227 mode tcp
11228 balance roundrobin
11229 stick store-request src
11230 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11231 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11232 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11233
11234 backend smtp
11235 mode tcp
11236 balance roundrobin
11237 stick match src table pop
11238 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11239 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11240
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011241 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011242
11243
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011244stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011245 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011246 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011247 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011249 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011250
11251 Arguments :
11252 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11253 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11254 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11255 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11256
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011257 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11258 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11259 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11260 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11261
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011262 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11263 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11264 instance.
11265
11266 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11267 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11268 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11269 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11270 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11271 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011272 to 32 characters.
11273
11274 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11275 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11276 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011277 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011278 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11279 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011280
11281 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011282 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11283 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011284 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11285 increase.
11286
11287 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011288 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11289 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11290 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011291
11292 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011293 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011294 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11295 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011296 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011297 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11298 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11299 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11300 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11301 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11302 parameter (see below).
11303
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011304 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11305 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11306 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11307 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11308 soft restart.
11309
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011310 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11311 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11312 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11313 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011314 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011315 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011316 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11317 if not expiration delay is specified.
11318
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011319 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11320 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11321 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11322 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11323 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11324 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11325 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11326 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11327 token.
11328
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011329 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11330 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11331 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11332 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011333 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11334 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11335 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11336 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11337 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11338 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11339 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11340 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11341 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11342 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11343 types and their arguments.
11344
11345 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11346 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11347 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11348 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11349
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011350 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
11351 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
11352 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
11353 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
11354 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
11355 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11356 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11357 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11358 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11359 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011360 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
11361 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
11362 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
11363 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011364
11365 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
11366 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
11367 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
11368 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
11369 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
11370 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
11371 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpc0 to gpc99,
11372 to ensure that the build of a peer update message can fit into the
11373 buffer. Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
11374 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
11375 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
11376 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011377 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
11378 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
11379 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
11380 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011381
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011382 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11383 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11384 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011385 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011386
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011387 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11388 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11389 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011390 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011391 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011392 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011393
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011394 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11395 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11396 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11397 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11398
11399 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11400 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11401 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11402 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11403 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11404 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11405
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011406 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
11407 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
11408 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
11409 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
11410 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
11411 elements: gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11412 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11413 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11414 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11415 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020011416 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
11417 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
11418 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011419
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011420 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11421 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11422 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11423 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11424
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011425 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11426 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11427 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11428 they were received.
11429
11430 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11431 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11432 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11433 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11434 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11435
11436 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11437 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11438 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11439 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11440 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11441
11442 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11443 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11444 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11445
11446 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11447 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11448 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11449 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11450 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11451
11452 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11453 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11454 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11455 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11456 the client side.
11457
11458 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11459 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11460 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11461 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11462 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11463 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11464 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11465
11466 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11467 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11468 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11469 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11470 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11471 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011472 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011473
11474 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11475 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11476 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11477 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11478 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11479 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11480
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011481 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11482 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11483 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11484 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11485 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11486
11487 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11488 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11489 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11490 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11491 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11492 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11493
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011494 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011495 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011496 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11497 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11498
11499 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11500 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11501 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11502 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11503 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11504 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11505 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11506 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11507 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11508 recommended for better fairness.
11509
11510 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011511 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011512 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11513 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11514
11515 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11516 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11517 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11518 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11519 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11520 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11521 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11522 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11523 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11524 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011525
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011526 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11527 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011528 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11529 reference it.
11530
11531 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11532 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011533 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11534 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11535 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011536
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011537 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11538 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11539 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11540 something that can be ignored.
11541
11542 Example:
11543 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11544 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11545 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11546 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11547
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011548 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011549 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011550
11551
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011552stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011553 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11555 no | no | yes | yes
11556
11557 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011558 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011559 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011560 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011561 server is selected.
11562
11563 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11564 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11565 the "stick-table" statement.
11566
11567 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11568 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11569 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11570 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11571
11572 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11573 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11574 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11575 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11576 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11577 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011578 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011579 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11580 rules.
11581
11582 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11583 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11584 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11585 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11586 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11587 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11588 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11589
11590 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11591 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11592 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11593 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11594
11595 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11596 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11597 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11598 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11599 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11600 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011601 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11602 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11603 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11604 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11605 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11606 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11607 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11608 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11609 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011610
11611 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11612
11613 Example :
11614 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11615 backend https
11616 mode tcp
11617 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011618 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011619 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011620
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011621 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11622 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11623
11624 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11625 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11626 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11627
11628 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11629 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011630
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011631 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11632 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11633 # at offset 44.
11634
11635 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11636 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11637
11638 # Learn on response if server hello.
11639 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011640
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011641 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11642 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11643
11644 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11645 extraction.
11646
11647
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011648tcp-check comment <string>
11649 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11650 it fails.
11651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11652 yes | no | yes | yes
11653
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011654 Arguments :
11655 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11656 rule fails.
11657
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011658 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11659 user-friendly error reporting.
11660
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011661 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11662 "tcp-check expect".
11663
11664
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011665tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11666 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011667 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011668 Opens a new connection
11669 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011670 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011671
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011672 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011673 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11674
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011675 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011676 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011677
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011678 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011679 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11680 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011681 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011682
11683 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011684
11685 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11686
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011687 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11688
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011689 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11690
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011691 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11692
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011693 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11694 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11695 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11696 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11697
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011698 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11699 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11700 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11701 haproxy -vv.
11702
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011703 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011704
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011705 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11706 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11707 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11708
11709 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11710 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11711 of the sequence.
11712
11713 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11714 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11715 do.
11716
11717 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11718 unset-var or comment rules.
11719
11720 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011721 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11722 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11723 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11724 option tcp-check
11725 tcp-check connect
11726 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11727 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11728 tcp-check send \r\n
11729 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11730 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11731 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11732 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11733 tcp-check send \r\n
11734 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11735 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11736
11737 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11738 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011739 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011740 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11741 tcp-check connect port 143
11742 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11743 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11744
11745 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11746
11747
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011748tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011749 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011750 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011751 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011752 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011753 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011754 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011755
11756 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011757 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11758
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011759 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11760 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11761 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11762 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11763 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11764 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11765 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11766 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11767 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11768 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11769
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011770 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011771 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11772 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011773 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11774 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11775 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11776
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011777 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11778 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11779 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011780 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11781 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011782 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11783 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011784 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11785 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011786 By default "L7OK" is used.
11787
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011788 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11789 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011790 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11791 supported :
11792 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11793 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011794 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11795 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11796 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11797 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11798 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011799
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011800 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011801 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011802 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11803 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11804 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11805 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011806 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11807
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011808 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11809 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11810 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11811 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11812
11813 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11814 informational message reported in logs if an error
11815 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11816 log-format string.
11817
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011818 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11819 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11820 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11821 followed by some converters.
11822
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011823 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11824 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11825 with the usual backslash ('\').
11826 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011827 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011828 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11829 used upper or lower case.
11830
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011831 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11832
11833 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11834 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11835 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11836 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11837 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11838 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11839 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11840 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11841
11842 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11843 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11844 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11845 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11846 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11847 expression.
11848
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011849 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11850 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11851 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11852 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11853 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11854 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11855
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011856 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11857 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11858 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11859 this exact hexadecimal string.
11860 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11861
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011862 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11863 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11864 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11865 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11866 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11867 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11868 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11869 size.
11870
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011871 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11872 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11873 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11874 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11875 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11876 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11877 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11878 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11879 in a binary string before matching the response's
11880 buffer.
11881
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011882 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011883 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011884 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11885 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11886 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11887 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11888 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11889 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11890 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11891 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11892 the null character.
11893
11894 Examples :
11895 # perform a POP check
11896 option tcp-check
11897 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11898
11899 # perform an IMAP check
11900 option tcp-check
11901 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11902
11903 # look for the redis master server
11904 option tcp-check
11905 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011906 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011907 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11908 tcp-check expect string role:master
11909 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11910 tcp-check expect string +OK
11911
11912
11913 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011914 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011915
11916
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011917tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11918tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11919 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11920 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011921 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011922 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011923
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011924 Arguments :
11925 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11926
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011927 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11928 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011929
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011930 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11931 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011932
11933 Examples :
11934 # look for the redis master server
11935 option tcp-check
11936 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11937 tcp-check expect string role:master
11938
11939 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011940 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011941
11942
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011943tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11944tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11945 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11946 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011947 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011948 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011949
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011950 Arguments :
11951 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011952
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011953 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11954 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011955
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011956 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11957 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11958 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011959
11960 Examples :
11961 # redis check in binary
11962 option tcp-check
11963 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11964 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11965
11966
11967 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011968 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011969
11970
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011971tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020011972tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011973 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011974 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011975 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011976
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011977 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011978 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11979 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11980 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11981 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11982 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11983 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11984 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11985 and '-'.
11986
11987 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11988
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020011989 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
11990 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
11991
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011992 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011993 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020011994 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011995
11996
11997tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011998 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011999 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012000 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012001
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012002 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012003 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12004 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12005 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12006 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12007 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12008 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12009 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12010 and '-'.
12011
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012012 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012013 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12014
12015
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012016tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12017 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12019 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012020 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012021 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12022 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012023
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012024 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012025
12026 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12027 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012028 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12029 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12030 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12031 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12032 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12033 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012034
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012035 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12036 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12037 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
12038 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012039
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012040 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012041 - accept :
12042 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12043 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12044 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012045
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012046 - reject :
12047 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12048 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12049 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
12050 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
12051 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
12052 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
12053 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
12054 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
12055 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
12056 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
12057 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012058 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012059
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012060 - expect-proxy layer4 :
12061 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12062 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
12063 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
12064 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
12065 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
12066 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12067 hosts.
12068
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012069 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
12070 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
12071 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
12072 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
12073 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
12074 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
12075 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
12076 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
12077
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012078 - capture <sample> len <length> :
12079 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
12080 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
12081 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
12082 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
12083 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
12084 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
12085 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
12086 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012087 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
12088 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012089
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012090 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012091 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012092 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12093 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12094 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012095 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012096 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012097 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12098 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12099 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12100 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12101 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12102 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12103 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012104
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012105 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012106 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012107 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012108 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012109 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12110 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12111 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012112
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012113 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12114 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12115 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12116 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012117
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012118 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12119 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12120 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12121 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12122 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012123 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12124 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12125 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12126 layer7 information is extracted.
12127
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012128 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12129 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12130 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12131 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12132 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012133
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012134 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>):
12135 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
12136 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
12137 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12138 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12139 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12140 no GPC stored at this index.
12141 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types
12142 (and not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate'
12143 data_types).
12144
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012145 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12146 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12147 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12148 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12149
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012150 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12151 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12152 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12153 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12154
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012155 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12156 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the
12157 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the
12158 value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
12159 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12160 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12161 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12162 no GPT stored at this index.
12163 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
12164 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
12165
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012166 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12167 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12168 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12169 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12170 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012171
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012172 - set-mark <mark>:
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +010012173 Is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the client
12174 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value
12175 is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by
12176 the routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace.
12177 It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
12178 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
12179 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works
12180 on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +010012181 on FreeBSD and OpenBSD.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012182
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012183 - set-src <expr> :
12184 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12185 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12186 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012187 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012188
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012189 Arguments:
12190 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12191 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012192
12193 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012194 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12195
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012196 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12197 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012198
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012199 - set-src-port <expr> :
12200 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12201 expression.
12202
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012203 Arguments:
12204 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12205 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012206
12207 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012208 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12209
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012210 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12211 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12212 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012213
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012214 - set-dst <expr> :
12215 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12216 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12217 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12218 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12219 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12220
12221 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12222 followed by some converters.
12223
12224 Example:
12225
12226 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12227 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12228
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012229 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12230 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12231
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012232 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12233 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12234 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12235 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12236
12237
12238 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12239 followed by some converters.
12240
12241 Example:
12242
12243 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12244
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012245 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12246 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12247 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12248
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012249 - set-tos <tos>:
12250 Is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12251 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
12252 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed
12253 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only
12254 the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
12255 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border
12256 routers based on some information from the request.
12257
12258 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
12259
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012260 - "silent-drop" :
12261 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012262 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012263 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12264 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12265 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12266 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12267 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012268 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12269 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012270 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12271 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012272 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012273 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12274 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12275 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12276 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12277
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012278 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12279 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12280 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012281
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012282 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12283 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12284 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012285
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012286 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012287 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012288 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012289
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012290 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12291 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12292 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012293
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012294 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012295 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12296 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012297
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012298 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12299
12300 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12301
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012302 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12303
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012304 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012305
12306
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012307tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12308 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012310 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012311 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012312 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12313 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012314
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012315 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012316
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012317 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012318 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12319 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012320 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12321 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012322
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012323 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12324 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12325 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12326 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012327 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012328 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012329 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12330 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12331 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12332 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012333 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012334 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012335
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012336 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12337 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12338 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12339 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012340
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012341 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012342 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012343 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012344 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12345 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012346 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012347 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012348 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012349 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012350 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012351 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012352 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012353 - set-dst <expr>
12354 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012355 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012356 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012357 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012358 - set-tos <tos>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012359 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012360 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012361 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012362 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012363 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012364 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012365 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012366
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012367 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12368 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012369 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12370 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012371
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012372 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12373 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12374 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12375 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12376 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12377 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012378
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012379 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012380 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12381 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012382
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012383 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12384 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12385 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12386 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12387 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12388 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12389
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012390 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012391 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12392 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12393 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12394 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12395 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12396 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12397 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12398 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12399 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12400 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012401
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012402 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012403 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12404 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12405 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012406
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012407 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12408 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12409
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012410 The "set-log-level" is used to set the log level of the current session. More
12411 information on how to use it at "http-request set-log-level".
12412
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012413 The "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK in all packets sent to the
12414 client. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-mark".
12415
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012416 The "set-nice" is used to set the "nice" factor of the current session. More
12417 information on how to use it at "http-request set-nice".
12418
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012419 The "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
12420 the client. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-tos".
12421
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012422 The "set-var" and "set-var-fmt" are used to set the contents of a variable.
12423 The variable is declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only
12424 session-level variables can be used, without any layer7 contents. The
12425 "set-var" action takes a regular expression while "set-var-fmt" takes a
12426 format string.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012427
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012428 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12429 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012430 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012431 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12432 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012433 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012434 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012435 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012436 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12437 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012438 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012439 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12440 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012441
12442 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12443 followed by some converters.
12444
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012445 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
12446 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
12447
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012448 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012449 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12450 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12451 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12452 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12453 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12454 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012455 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012456 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12457 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12458
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012459 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12460
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012461 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12462 <var-name>.
12463
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012464 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12465 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12466 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12467 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12468 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12469
12470 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12471 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12472 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12473 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12474 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12475 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12476 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12477 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12478 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12479 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12480 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12481
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012482 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12483 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12484 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12485 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12486 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12487
12488 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12489
12490 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12491
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012492 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12493 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12494 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12495 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12496 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12497 evaluated.
12498
12499 Example:
12500 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12501
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012502 Example:
12503
12504 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012505 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012506 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012507
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012508 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012509 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012510 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012511 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12512 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012513 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012514 tcp-request content reject
12515
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012516 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12517 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12518 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12519 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12520 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12521 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12522 ...
12523 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12524
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012525 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012526 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12527 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12528 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012529 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012530
12531 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12532 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12533 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012534 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012535 tcp-request content reject
12536
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012537 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012538 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012539 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012540 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012541 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12542 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012543
12544 Example:
12545 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12546 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012547 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012548
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012549 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012550 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012551
12552 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012553 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012554 # protecting all our sites
12555 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012556 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12557 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012558 ...
12559 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12560
12561 backend http_dynamic
12562 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012563 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012564 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012565 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012566 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012567 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012568 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012569
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012570 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012571
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012572 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12573 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012574
12575
12576tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12577 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012579 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012580 Arguments :
12581 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12582 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12583 as explained at the top of this document.
12584
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012585 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012586 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12587 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12588 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12589 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12590
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012591 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12592 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12593 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12594 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12595
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012596 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012597 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012598 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012599 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012600 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012601 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12602 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12603 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012604
12605 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12606 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12607 it pass through unaffected.
12608
12609 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12610 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12611 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012612 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012613 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12614 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012615 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12616 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12617 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012618
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012619 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012620 "timeout client".
12621
12622
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012623tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12624 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12626 no | no | yes | yes
12627 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012628 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12629 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012630
12631 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12632
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012633 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012634 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12635 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012636 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12637 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012638
12639 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12640
12641 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12642 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12643 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12644 inserted.
12645
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012646 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012647 - accept :
12648 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12649 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12650 the rules evaluation.
12651
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012652 - close :
12653 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12654 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12655 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12656 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12657 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12658 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012659 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012660 protocols.
12661
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012662 - reject :
12663 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12664 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012665 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012666
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012667 - set-log-level <level>
12668 The "set-log-level" is used to set the log level of the current
12669 session. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12670 set-log-level".
12671
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012672 - set-mark <mark>
12673 The "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK in all packets sent to
12674 the client. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12675 set-mark".
12676
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012677 - set-nice <nice>
12678 The "set-nice" is used to set the "nice" factor of the current
12679 session. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12680 set-nice".
12681
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012682 - set-tos <tos>
12683 The "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets
12684 sent to the client. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12685 set-tos".
12686
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012687 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreaue7267122021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012688 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012689
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012690 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
12691 Sets a variable from a log format string.
12692
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012693 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12694 Unsets a variable.
12695
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012696 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>):
12697 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
12698 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
12699 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12700 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12701 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12702 no GPC stored at this index.
12703 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types
12704 (and not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate'
12705 data_types).
12706
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012707 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12708 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12709 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12710 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12711
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012712 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12713 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12714 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12715 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12716
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012717 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12718 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the
12719 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the
12720 value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
12721 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12722 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12723 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12724 no GPT stored at this index.
12725 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
12726 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
12727
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012728 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12729 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12730 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12731 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12732 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012733
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012734 - "silent-drop" :
12735 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012736 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012737 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12738 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12739 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12740 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12741 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012742 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12743 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012744 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12745 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012746 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012747 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12748 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12749 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12750 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12751
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012752 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12753 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12754
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012755 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12756 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12757 for changing the default action to a reject.
12758
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012759 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12760 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12761 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12762 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012763 period.
12764
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012765 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12766 declared inline.
12767
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012768 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12769 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012770 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012771 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12772 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012773 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012774 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012775 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012776 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12777 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012778 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012779 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12780 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012781
12782 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12783 followed by some converters.
12784
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012785 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
12786 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
12787
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012788 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12789 <var-name>.
12790
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012791 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12792 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12793 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12794 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12795 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12796
12797 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12798
12799 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12800
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012801 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12802
12803 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12804
12805
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012806tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12807 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12809 no | yes | yes | no
12810 Arguments :
12811 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12812 below.
12813
12814 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12815
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012816 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012817 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12818 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12819 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12820 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12821 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12822 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12823 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012824 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012825 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12826 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12827 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12828 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12829 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12830 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12831 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12832 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12833 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12834 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12835 instead.
12836
12837 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12838 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12839 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12840 rules which may be inserted.
12841
12842 Several types of actions are supported :
12843 - accept : the request is accepted
12844 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12845 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012846 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012847 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012848 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012849 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012850 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012851 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet14aec6e2021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012852 - set-dst <expr>
12853 - set-dst-port <expr>
12854 - set-src <expr>
12855 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012856 - set-tos <tos>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012857 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012858 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012859 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012860 - silent-drop
12861
12862 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12863 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12864 sections for a complete description.
12865
12866 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12867 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12868 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12869
12870 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12871 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12872 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12873 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12874 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12875
12876 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12877 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12878
12879 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12880 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12881 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12882
12883 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12884 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12885 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12886
12887 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12888 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12889 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12890
12891 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12892 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12893 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12894
12895 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12896
12897 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12898
12899
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012900tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12901 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12903 no | no | yes | yes
12904 Arguments :
12905 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12906 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12907 as explained at the top of this document.
12908
12909 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12910
12911
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012912timeout check <timeout>
12913 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12914 established.
12915
12916 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12917 yes | no | yes | yes
12918 Arguments:
12919 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12920 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12921 as explained at the top of this document.
12922
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012923 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012924 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012925 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012926 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012927 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12928 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12929 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012930
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012931 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012932 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12933
12934 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12935 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012936 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012937
12938 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12939 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12940 forget about it.
12941
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012942 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12943 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012944
12945
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012946timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012947 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12949 yes | yes | yes | no
12950 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012951 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012952 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12953 as explained at the top of this document.
12954
12955 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12956 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12957 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012958 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12959 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12960 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12961 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012962 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12963 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12964 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012965 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012966 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012967 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12968 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012969 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12970 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012971
12972 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12973 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12974 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12975 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012976 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012977 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12978
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012979 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012980
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012981 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012982
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012983
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012984timeout client-fin <timeout>
12985 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12987 yes | yes | yes | no
12988 Arguments :
12989 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12990 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12991 as explained at the top of this document.
12992
12993 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12994 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12995 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12996 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12997 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12998 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12999 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010013000 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
13001 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
13002 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013003
13004 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13005 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13006 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
13007
13008 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
13009
13010
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013011timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013012 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
13013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13014 yes | no | yes | yes
13015 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013016 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013017 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13018 as explained at the top of this document.
13019
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013020 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013021 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013022 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013023 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013024 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
13025 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013026
13027 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13028 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13029 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13030 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013031 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013032 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13033
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013034 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013035
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013036
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013037timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
13038 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
13039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13040 yes | yes | yes | yes
13041 Arguments :
13042 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13043 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13044 as explained at the top of this document.
13045
13046 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
13047 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
13048 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
13049 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
13050 once the request has started to present itself.
13051
13052 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
13053 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
13054 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
13055 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
13056 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
13057
13058 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
13059 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
13060 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
13061 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
13062
13063 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
13064 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013065 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013066 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
13067 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013068 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013069
13070 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
13071 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
13072 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
13073 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
13074
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013075 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
13076 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010013077 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
13078
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013079 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
13080
13081
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013082timeout http-request <timeout>
13083 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
13084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013085 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013086 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013087 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013088 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13089 as explained at the top of this document.
13090
13091 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13092 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13093 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13094 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13095 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13096 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13097 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013098 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13099 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13100 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13101 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013102 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013103 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13104 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013105
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013106 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13107 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13108 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13109 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13110 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013111 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013112
13113 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13114 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013115 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013116 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13117 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13118
13119 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013120 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13121 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13122 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013123
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013124 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013125 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013126
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013127
13128timeout queue <timeout>
13129 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13131 yes | no | yes | yes
13132 Arguments :
13133 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13134 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13135 as explained at the top of this document.
13136
13137 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13138 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13139 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13140 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13141 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13142
13143 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13144 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13145 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13146 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13147
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013148 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013149
13150
13151timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013152 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13154 yes | no | yes | yes
13155 Arguments :
13156 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13157 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13158 as explained at the top of this document.
13159
13160 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13161 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13162 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13163 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13164 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13165 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13166 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13167
13168 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13169 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13170 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13171 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13172 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013173 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013174 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013175 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13176 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013177 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13178 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013179
13180 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13181 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13182 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13183 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013184 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013185 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13186
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013187 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013188
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013189
13190timeout server-fin <timeout>
13191 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13193 yes | no | yes | yes
13194 Arguments :
13195 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13196 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13197 as explained at the top of this document.
13198
13199 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13200 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13201 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13202 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13203 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13204 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13205 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13206 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13207 situations, it should not be needed.
13208
13209 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13210 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13211 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13212
13213 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13214
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013215
13216timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013217 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13219 yes | yes | yes | yes
13220 Arguments :
13221 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13222 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13223 as explained at the top of this document.
13224
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013225 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13226 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13227 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013228
13229 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13230 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13231 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13232 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013233 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013234
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013235 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013236
13237
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013238timeout tunnel <timeout>
13239 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13241 yes | no | yes | yes
13242 Arguments :
13243 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13244 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13245 as explained at the top of this document.
13246
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013247 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013248 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13249 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13250 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013251 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13252 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013253 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13254 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13255 specified.
13256
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013257 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13258 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13259 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13260 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13261 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13262 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13263 state.
13264
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013265 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13266 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13267 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13268 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013269 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013270
13271 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13272 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13273 forget about it.
13274
13275 Example :
13276 defaults http
13277 option http-server-close
13278 timeout connect 5s
13279 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013280 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013281 timeout server 30s
13282 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13283
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013284 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013285
13286
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013287transparent (deprecated)
13288 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013290 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013291 Arguments : none
13292
13293 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13294 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13295 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13296 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13297 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13298 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13299 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13300 appropriate server.
13301
13302 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13303
13304 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13305 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13306
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013307 See also: "option transparent"
13308
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013309unique-id-format <string>
13310 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13312 yes | yes | yes | no
13313 Arguments :
13314 <string> is a log-format string.
13315
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013316 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13317 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13318 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13319 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013320
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013321 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013322 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013323 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13324 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13325 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13326 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13327 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13328 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013329
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013330 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13331 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013332
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013333 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013334
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013335 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013336
13337 will generate:
13338
13339 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13340
13341 See also: "unique-id-header"
13342
13343unique-id-header <name>
13344 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13346 yes | yes | yes | no
13347 Arguments :
13348 <name> is the name of the header.
13349
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013350 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13351 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013352
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013353 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013354
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013355 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013356 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13357
13358 will generate:
13359
13360 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13361
13362 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013363
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013364use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013365 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13367 no | yes | yes | no
13368 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013369 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13370 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013371
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013372 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13373 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013374
13375 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13376 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13377 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013378 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013379 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013380 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13381 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013382
13383 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13384 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13385 assign the backend.
13386
13387 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13388 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13389 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13390 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13391 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13392 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13393
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013394 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013395 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013396 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13397 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13398 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13399
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013400 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13401 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13402 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13403 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13404 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13405 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13406 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13407 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13408 cannot be forced from the request.
13409
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013410 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013411 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13412 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13413
13414 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13415 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013416
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013417use-fcgi-app <name>
13418 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13420 no | no | yes | yes
13421 Arguments :
13422 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13423
13424 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013425
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013426use-server <server> if <condition>
13427use-server <server> unless <condition>
13428 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13430 no | no | yes | yes
13431 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013432 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13433 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013434
13435 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13436
13437 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13438 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13439 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13440
13441 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13442 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13443 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13444 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13445 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13446 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13447 matches will assign the server.
13448
13449 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13450 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13451 with the next rules until one matches.
13452
13453 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13454 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13455 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13456 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13457
13458 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13459 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13460 stripped.
13461
13462 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13463 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013464 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013465 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013466 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013467
13468 Example :
13469 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013470 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013471 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013472 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013473 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013474 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013475 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013476 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13477 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13478
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013479 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13480 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13481 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13482 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013483 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013484 and we fall back to load balancing.
13485
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013486 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013487
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013488
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134895. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013490--------------------------
13491
13492The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13493depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13494settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13495written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13496described in this section.
13497
13498
134995.1. Bind options
13500-----------------
13501
13502The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13503as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13504no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13505parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13506while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13507provided immediately after the setting name.
13508
13509The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13510
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013511accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13512 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13513 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13514 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13515 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13516 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13517 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13518 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13519 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13520 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013521 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13522 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13523 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013524
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013525accept-proxy
13526 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013527 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13528 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013529 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13530 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13531 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13532 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013533 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013534 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13535 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013536 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13537 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013538
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013539allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013540 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013541 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013542 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013543 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13544 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013545
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013546alpn <protocols>
13547 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13548 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13549 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013550 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013551 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013552 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13553 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13554 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13555 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13556 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13557 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13558 preference, like below :
13559
13560 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013561
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013562backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013563 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013564 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13565
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013566curves <curves>
13567 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13568 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13569 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13570 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13571 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13572 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13573
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013574ecdhe <named curve>
13575 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013576 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13577 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013578
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013579ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013580 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13581 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13582 client's certificate.
13583
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013584ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13585 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13586 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13587 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13588 error is ignored.
13589
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013590ca-sign-file <cafile>
13591 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13592 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13593 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13594 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13595 'generate-certificates' for details.
13596
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013597ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013598 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13599 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13600 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13601 'generate-certificates' for details.
13602
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013603ca-verify-file <cafile>
13604 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13605 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13606 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13607 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13608 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13609
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013610ciphers <ciphers>
13611 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13612 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013613 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013614 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013615 information and recommendations see e.g.
13616 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13617 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13618 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13619
13620ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13621 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13622 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13623 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13624 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013625 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13626 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013627
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013628crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013629 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13630 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013631 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13632 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013633
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013634crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013635 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13636 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13637 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13638 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13639 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013640 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13641 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013642
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013643 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13644 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13645
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013646 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13647 are loaded.
13648
13649 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013650 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13651 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13652 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13653 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13654 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13655 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13656 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013657 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013658
13659 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13660 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13661 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13662 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013663 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13664 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013665
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013666 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013667
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013668 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013669 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013670 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13671 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013672 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13673 clients).
13674
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013675 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013676 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13677 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13678 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13679 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13680 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13681 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13682 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13683 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13684 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13685 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13686 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13687 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13688
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013689 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013690 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13691 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13692 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13693 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13694
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013695 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13696 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13697 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13698 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013699
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013700 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13701 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13702 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013703
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013704crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013705 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013706 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013707 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013708 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013709
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013710crt-list <file>
13711 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013712 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13713 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013714
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013715 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13716
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013717 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13718 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13719 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13720 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13721 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013722
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013723 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013724 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13725 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13726 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13727 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13728 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013729 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13730 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13731 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013732
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013733 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13734 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13735 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013736
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013737 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13738
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013739 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013740 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013741 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13742 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13743 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13744 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13745 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13746 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013747
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013748 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013749 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013750 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013751 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013752 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013753 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013754
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013755defer-accept
13756 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13757 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13758 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013759 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013760 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13761 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13762 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13763 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13764 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13765 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13766 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13767
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013768expose-fd listeners
13769 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13770 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013771 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13772 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013773 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013774
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013775force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013776 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013777 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013778 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013779 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013780
13781force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013782 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013783 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013784 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013785
13786force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013787 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013788 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013789 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013790
13791force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013792 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013793 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013794 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013795
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013796force-tlsv13
13797 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13798 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013799 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013800
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013801generate-certificates
13802 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13803 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13804 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13805 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13806 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13807 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13808 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13809 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13810 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13811 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13812 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13813
13814 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13815 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013816 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013817 certificate is used many times.
13818
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013819gid <gid>
13820 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13821 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13822 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13823 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13824 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13825
13826group <group>
13827 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13828 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13829 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13830 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13831 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13832
13833id <id>
13834 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13835 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13836 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13837 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13838
13839interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013840 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13841 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13842 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13843 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13844 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13845 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013846 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13847 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13848 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13849 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13850 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13851 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013852
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013853level <level>
13854 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13855 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13856 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013857 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013858 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13859 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13860 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013861 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013862 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013863 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013864 all counters).
13865
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013866severity-output <format>
13867 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13868 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13869 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13870 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13871 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13872 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13873 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13874 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13875 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13876 rfc5424 convention.
13877
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013878maxconn <maxconn>
13879 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13880 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13881 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13882 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13883 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13884 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13885 eat all memory.
13886
13887mode <mode>
13888 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13889 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13890 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13891 UNIX sockets.
13892
13893mss <maxseg>
13894 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13895 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13896 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13897 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13898 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13899 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13900 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13901 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13902 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13903 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13904 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13905
13906name <name>
13907 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13908 page.
13909
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013910namespace <name>
13911 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13912 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13913 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13914 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13915
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013916nice <nice>
13917 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13918 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13919 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13920 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13921 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13922 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13923 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13924 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13925 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13926 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13927 one for an RDP socket.
13928
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013929no-ca-names
13930 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13931 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013932 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013933
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013934no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013935 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013936 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013937 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013938 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013939 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13940 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013941
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013942no-tls-tickets
13943 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13944 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13945 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013946 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13947 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013948 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13949 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13950 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013951
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013952no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013953 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013954 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013955 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013956 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013957 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13958 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013959
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013960no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013961 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013962 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013963 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013964 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013965 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13966 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013967
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013968no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013969 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013970 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013971 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013972 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013973 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13974 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013975
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013976no-tlsv13
13977 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13978 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13979 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13980 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013981 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13982 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013983
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013984npn <protocols>
13985 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13986 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13987 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013988 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013989 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013990 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13991 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13992 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13993 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13994 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013995
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013996prefer-client-ciphers
13997 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13998 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13999 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020014000 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
14001 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
14002 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014003
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010014004process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020014005 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14006 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. Note
14007 that only process number 1 is permitted. If a thread set is specified, it
14008 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
14009 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
14010 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010014011
14012 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14013
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014014 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020014015 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14016 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14017 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14018 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14019 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020014020
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014021 This directive is deprecated in favor of the more suited "thread" directive
14022 below, and will be removed in 2.7.
14023
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014024proto <name>
14025 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
14026 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
14027 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014028 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
14029 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14030
14031 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14032 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14033 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14034 also reported (flag=HTX).
14035
14036 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14037 a bind line :
14038
14039 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14040 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14041 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14042
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014043 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014044 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080014045 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014046 h2" on the bind line.
14047
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014048ssl
14049 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014050 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014051 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
14052 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020014053 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
14054 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014055
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014056ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14057 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014058 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
14059 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
14060 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014061 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14062
14063ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014064 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
14065 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
14066 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
14067 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014068
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010014069strict-sni
14070 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
14071 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
14072 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
14073 See the "crt" option for more information.
14074
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014075tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014076 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014077 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014078 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014079 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014080 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
14081 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
14082 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
14083 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
14084 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
14085 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
14086 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14087
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014088tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010014089 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014090 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
14091 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
14092 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14093 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14094 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14095 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14096 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014097 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14098 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14099 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014100
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014101thread <thread-set>
14102 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14103 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
14104 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
14105 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
14106 repeated. <thread-set> must use the format:
14107
14108 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14109
14110 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
14111 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14112 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14113 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14114 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14115 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
14116
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014117tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14118 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014119 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14120 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14121 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14122 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14123 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14124 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14125 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14126 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14127 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14128 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014129 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14130 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14131
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014132transparent
14133 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14134 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14135 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14136 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14137 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14138 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14139 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14140 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14141 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14142 so check for support with your vendor.
14143
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014144v4v6
14145 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14146 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14147 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14148 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014149 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014150
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014151v6only
14152 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14153 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14154 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014155 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14156 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014157
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014158uid <uid>
14159 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14160 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14161 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14162 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14163 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14164
14165user <user>
14166 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14167 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14168 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14169 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14170 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14171
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014172verify [none|optional|required]
14173 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14174 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14175 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14176 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14177 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014178 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14179 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14180 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14181 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014182
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200141835.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014184------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014185
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014186The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14187which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14188arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14189settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14190after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14191Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14192address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014194 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014195 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014196
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014197Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14198keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14199
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014200The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014201
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014202addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014203 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014204 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14205 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14206 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14207 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14208 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014209
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014210agent-check
14211 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014212 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014213 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14214 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14215 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014216
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014217 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014218 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014219 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014220 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14221 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014222
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014223 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14224 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14225 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14226 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14227 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014228
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014229 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014230 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014231
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014232 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14233 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14234 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014235
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014236 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14237 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14238 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014239
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014240 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014241 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14242 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14243 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14244 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014245 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014246 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014247
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014248 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14249 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014250
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014251 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14252 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14253 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14254 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14255 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14256 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14257 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14258 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14259 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014260
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014261 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14262 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014263 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14264 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14265 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014266 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014267
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014268 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014269 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014270
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014271agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014272 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014273 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14274 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14275 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14276 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14277
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014278agent-inter <delay>
14279 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14280 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14281
14282 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14283 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14284 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14285 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14286 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14287 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14288 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14289 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14290 of backends use the same servers.
14291
14292 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14293
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014294agent-addr <addr>
14295 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14296
14297 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014298 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014299 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14300 hostname, it will be resolved.
14301
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014302agent-port <port>
14303 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14304
14305 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14306
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014307allow-0rtt
14308 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014309 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14310 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014311
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014312alpn <protocols>
14313 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14314 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14315 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014316 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014317 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14318 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14319 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14320 now obsolete NPN extension.
14321 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14322 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14323
14324 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14325
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014326backup
14327 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14328 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14329 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14330 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014331 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14332 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014333
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014334ca-file <cafile>
14335 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14336 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14337 server's certificate.
14338
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014339check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014340 This option enables health checks on a server:
14341 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14342 considered available.
14343 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14344 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14345 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14346 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14347 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14348 set.
14349 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14350 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14351 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14352 exchanges succeed.
14353
14354 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14355 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14356 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14357 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14358 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014359 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014360 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14361
14362 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14363 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14364
14365 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14366 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14367
14368 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14369 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14370 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14371 available.
14372
14373 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14374 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14375 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14376
14377 Example:
14378 # simple tcp check
14379 backend foo
14380 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14381 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14382 backend foo
14383 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14384 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14385 backend foo
14386 option tcp-check
14387 tcp-check connect
14388 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014389
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014390check-send-proxy
14391 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14392 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14393 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14394 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14395 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14396 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14397 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14398
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014399check-alpn <protocols>
14400 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14401 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14402 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14403
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014404check-proto <name>
14405 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14406 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14407 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014408 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14409 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14410
14411 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14412 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14413 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14414 also reported (flag=HTX).
14415
14416 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14417 directive on a server line:
14418
14419 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14420 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14421 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14422 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14423
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014424 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014425 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14426 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14427
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014428check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014429 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014430 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14431 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014432
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014433check-ssl
14434 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14435 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14436 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14437 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014438 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014439 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14440 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014441 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014442 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14443 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014444
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014445check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014446 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014447 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14448 for normal traffic.
14449
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014450ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014451 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14452 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14453 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014454 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14455 information and recommendations see e.g.
14456 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14457 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14458 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014459
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014460ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14461 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14462 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14463 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14464 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014465 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14466 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14467 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014468
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014469cookie <value>
14470 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14471 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14472 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14473 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14474 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14475 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14476 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14477
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014478crl-file <crlfile>
14479 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14480 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14481 to verify server's certificate.
14482
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014483crt <cert>
14484 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14485 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14486 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14487 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14488 certificate request.
14489
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014490 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14491 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14492 option is set accordingly).
14493
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014494disabled
14495 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14496 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14497 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14498 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14499 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014500 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014501
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014502enabled
14503 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14504 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14505 default value.
14506 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14507 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014508
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014509error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014510 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14511 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14512 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014514 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014516fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014517 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14518 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14519 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14520
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014521force-sslv3
14522 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14523 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014524 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014525 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014526
14527force-tlsv10
14528 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014529 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014530 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014531
14532force-tlsv11
14533 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014534 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014535 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014536
14537force-tlsv12
14538 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014539 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014540 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014541
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014542force-tlsv13
14543 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14544 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014545 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014546
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014547id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014548 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14549 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14550 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014551
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014552init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14553 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14554 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014555 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014556 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14557 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14558 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14559 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14560 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14561 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14562 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14563 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14564 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014565 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014566 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14567 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14568 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14569 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14570 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14571 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014572 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014573
14574 Example:
14575 defaults
14576 # never fail on address resolution
14577 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14578
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014579inter <delay>
14580fastinter <delay>
14581downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014582 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14583 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14584 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14585 between checks depending on the server state :
14586
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014587 Server state | Interval used
14588 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14589 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14590 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14591 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14592 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14593 or yet unchecked. |
14594 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14595 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14596 | "inter" otherwise.
14597 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014598
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014599 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14600 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14601 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14602 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014603 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14604 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14605 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14606 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14607 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014608
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014609log-proto <logproto>
14610 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14611 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14612 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14613 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14614
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014615maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014616 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14617 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014618 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14619 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014620 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14621 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14622 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14623 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14624
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014625 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14626 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14627 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14628 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14629 than 50 concurrent requests.
14630
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014631maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014632 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14633 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14634 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14635 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014636 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14637 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14638 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14639 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14640 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14641 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14642 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014643
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014644max-reuse <count>
14645 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14646 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14647 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14648 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14649 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14650 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14651 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14652 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14653
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014654minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014655 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14656 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14657 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14658 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14659 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14660 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014661 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014662 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014663
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014664namespace <name>
14665 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14666 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14667 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14668 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14669
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014670no-agent-check
14671 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14672 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14673 default value.
14674 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14675 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14676
14677no-backup
14678 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14679 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14680 default value.
14681 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14682 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14683
14684no-check
14685 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14686 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14687 default value.
14688 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14689 "default-server" "check" setting.
14690
14691no-check-ssl
14692 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14693 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14694 default value.
14695 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14696 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14697
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014698no-send-proxy
14699 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14700 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14701 default value.
14702 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14703 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14704
14705no-send-proxy-v2
14706 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14707 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14708 default value.
14709 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14710 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14711
14712no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14713 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14714 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14715 default value.
14716 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14717 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14718
14719no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14720 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14721 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14722 default value.
14723 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14724 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14725
14726no-ssl
14727 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14728 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14729 default value.
14730 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14731 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14732
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014733 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14734 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14735 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14736
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014737no-ssl-reuse
14738 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14739 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14740 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14741 and for paranoid users.
14742
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014743no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014744 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14745 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014746 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014747
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014748 Supported in default-server: No
14749
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014750no-tls-tickets
14751 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14752 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14753 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014754 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14755 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014756 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14757 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14758 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014759 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014760
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014761no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014762 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014763 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14764 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014765 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14766 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014767 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014768
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014769 Supported in default-server: No
14770
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014771no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014772 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014773 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14774 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014775 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14776 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014777 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014778
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014779 Supported in default-server: No
14780
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014781no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014782 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014783 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14784 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014785 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14786 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014787 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014788
14789 Supported in default-server: No
14790
14791no-tlsv13
14792 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14793 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14794 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14795 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14796 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014797 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014798
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014799 Supported in default-server: No
14800
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014801no-verifyhost
14802 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14803 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14804 default value.
14805 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14806 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014807
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014808no-tfo
14809 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14810 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14811 default value.
14812 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14813 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14814
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014815non-stick
14816 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14817 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14818 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14819
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014820npn <protocols>
14821 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14822 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14823 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014824 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014825 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14826 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14827 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14828
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014829observe <mode>
14830 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14831 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14832 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14833 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14834 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14835 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014836 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014837
14838 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14839
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014840on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014841 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14842 Currently, four modes are available:
14843 - fastinter: force fastinter
14844 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14845 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14846 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14847 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14848
14849 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14850
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014851on-marked-down <action>
14852 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14853 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014854 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14855 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14856 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14857 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14858 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14859 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14860 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14861 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014862
14863 Actions are disabled by default
14864
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014865on-marked-up <action>
14866 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14867 Currently one action is available:
14868 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14869 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14870 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14871 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014872 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14873 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014874 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14875 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14876
14877 Actions are disabled by default
14878
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014879pool-low-conn <max>
14880 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14881 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14882 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14883 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14884 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14885 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14886 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14887 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14888 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14889 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014890 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14891 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14892 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14893 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014894
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014895pool-max-conn <max>
14896 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14897 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14898 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14899 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14900 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14901 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14902
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014903pool-purge-delay <delay>
14904 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014905 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014906 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014907
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014908port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014909 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014910 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14911 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14912 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14913 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14914 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014915
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014916proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014917 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14918 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14919 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014920 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14921 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14922
14923 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14924 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14925 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14926 also reported (flag=HTX).
14927
14928 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14929 a server line :
14930
14931 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14932 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14933 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14934 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14935
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014936 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014937 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14938
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014939redir <prefix>
14940 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14941 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14942 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14943 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14944 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14945 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14946 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14947 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014948 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014949 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014950 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14951 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14952 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14953 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14954
14955 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014957rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014958 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14959 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14960 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14961
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014962resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14963 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14964 server.
14965
14966 Available options:
14967
14968 * allow-dup-ip
14969 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14970 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14971 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14972 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14973 For such case, simply enable this option.
14974 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14975
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014976 * ignore-weight
14977 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14978 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14979 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14980
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014981 * prevent-dup-ip
14982 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14983 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14984 same fqdn.
14985 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14986
14987 Example:
14988 backend b_myapp
14989 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14990 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14991 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14992
14993 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14994 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14995 it
14996 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14997 different address
14998
14999 Default value: not set
15000
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015001resolve-prefer <family>
15002 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
15003 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
15004 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
15005 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
15006
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020015007 Default value: ipv6
15008
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015009 Example:
15010
15011 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015012
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015013resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015014 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015015 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015016 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015017 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
15018 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015019 configured network, another address is selected.
15020
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015021 Example:
15022
15023 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015024
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015025resolvers <id>
15026 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
15027 hostname.
15028
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015029 Example:
15030
15031 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015032
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015033 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015034
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015035send-proxy
15036 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
15037 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
15038 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
15039 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015040 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
15041 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
15042 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
15043 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015044 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015045 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
15046 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
15047 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
15048 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
15049 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015050 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
15051 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015052
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015053send-proxy-v2
15054 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
15055 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15056 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15057 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020015058 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
15059 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
15060 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
15061 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015062
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015063proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010015064 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
15065 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
15066
15067 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
15068 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
15069 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
15070 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
15071 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
15072 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
15073 connection is supported).
15074 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
15075 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
15076 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
15077 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
15078 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
15079 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
15080 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015081
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015082send-proxy-v2-ssl
15083 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15084 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15085 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15086 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15087 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15088 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
15089 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015090 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
15091 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015092
15093send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15094 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15095 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15096 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15097 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15098 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15099 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
15100 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
15101 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015102 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
15103 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015104
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015105slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015106 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15107 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15108 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15109 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15110 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15111 parameters :
15112
15113 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15114 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15115
15116 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15117 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15118 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15119 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15120
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015121 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015122 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15123 seen as failed.
15124
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015125sni <expression>
15126 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15127 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15128 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
15129 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015130 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
15131 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015132 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015133 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15134 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015135
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015136source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015137source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015138source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015139 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15140 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15141 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15142 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15143
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015144 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15145 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15146 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15147 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15148 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15149 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15150 server.
15151
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015152 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15153 specifying the source address without port(s).
15154
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015155ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015156 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15157 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15158 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15159 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15160 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15161 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015162 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15163 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015164
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015165ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15166 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15167 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15168 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15169
15170ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15171 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15172 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15173 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15174
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015175ssl-reuse
15176 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15177 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15178 default value.
15179 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15180 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15181
15182stick
15183 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15184 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15185 default value.
15186 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15187 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015188
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015189socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015190 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015191 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15192 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15193
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015194tcp-ut <delay>
15195 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015196 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015197 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015198 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015199 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15200 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15201 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15202 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15203 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15204 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15205 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15206 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15207 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15208
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015209tfo
15210 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15211 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15212 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15213 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015214 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015215 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015216
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015217track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015218 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15219 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15220 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15221 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015222 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15223
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015224tls-tickets
15225 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15226 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15227 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015228 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15229 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15230 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015231 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015232 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015233
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015234verify [none|required]
15235 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015236 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015237 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15238 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015239 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015240 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15241 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15242 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15243 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15244 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15245 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15246 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15247 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015248
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015249verifyhost <hostname>
15250 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015251 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15252 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15253 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15254 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15255 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15256 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15257 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15258 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015259
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015260weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015261 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15262 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15263 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015264 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15265 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15266 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15267 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15268 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15269 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015270
15271
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152725.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15273-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015274
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015275HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15276using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015277configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015278This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15279can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15280workload.
15281This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15282resolution at run time.
15283Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15284carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15285
15286
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152875.3.1. Global overview
15288----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015289
15290As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15291different steps of the process life:
15292
15293 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15294 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15295 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15296
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015297 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15298 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015299
15300A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15301 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15302 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15303 resolution to know this new IP.
15304
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015305When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015306HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015307SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15308from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015309will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015310will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015311
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015312A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015313 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015314 first valid response.
15315
15316 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15317 servers return an error.
15318
15319
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200153205.3.2. The resolvers section
15321----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015322
15323This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015324HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15325contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015326
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015327When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15328uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15329is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15330answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15331
15332When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015333used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015334
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015335 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15336 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15337 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015338
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015339 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15340 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015341
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015342 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15343 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15344 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015345
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015346For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15347following scenarios are possible:
15348
15349 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15350 ignored
15351
15352 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15353 applied
15354
15355 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15356 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15357
15358 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15359 retries the query with a new type
15360
15361 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15362 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015363
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015364As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015365a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015366<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015367
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015368
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015369resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015370 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015371
15372A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15373
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015374accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015375 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015376 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015377 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15378 by RFC 6891)
15379
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015380 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15381 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15382 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15383 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15384 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15385 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015386
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015387nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15388 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15389 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15390 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15391 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15392 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15393 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15394 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15395 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15396 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015397 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15398
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015399parse-resolv-conf
15400 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15401 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15402 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15403
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015404hold <status> <period>
15405 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15406 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015407 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015408 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015409 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15410 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15411 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15412
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015413 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015414
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015415resolve_retries <nb>
15416 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15417 giving up.
15418 Default value: 3
15419
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015420 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15421 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15422 type.
15423
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015424timeout <event> <time>
15425 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15426 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15427 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015428 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15429 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015430 Default value: 1s
15431 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015432 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015433 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015434 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15435 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15436
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015437 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015438
15439 resolvers mydns
15440 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15441 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015442 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015443 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015444 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015445 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015446 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015447 hold other 30s
15448 hold refused 30s
15449 hold nx 30s
15450 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015451 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015452 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015453
15454
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200154556. Cache
15456---------
15457
15458HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15459(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15460RAM.
15461
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020015462The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
15463blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015464
15465If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15466independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15467when we try to allocate a new one.
15468
15469The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15470
15471It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15472"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15473for more details.
15474
15475When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15476replaced by "<CACHE>".
15477
15478
154796.1. Limitation
15480----------------
15481
15482The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15483
15484- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015485- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15486 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15487 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015488- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15489- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015490- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15491 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15492 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015493- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15494 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015495- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15496 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15497 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015498
15499- If the request is not a GET
15500- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15501- If the request contains an Authorization header
15502
15503
155046.2. Setup
15505-----------
15506
15507To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15508the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15509
15510
155116.2.1. Cache section
15512---------------------
15513
15514cache <name>
15515 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15516 size of cache is mandatory.
15517
15518total-max-size <megabytes>
15519 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15520 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15521
15522max-object-size <bytes>
15523 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15524 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15525 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15526
15527max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015528 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015529 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15530 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15531 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15532 default.
15533
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015534process-vary <on/off>
15535 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015536 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15537 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15538 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015539 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015540
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015541max-secondary-entries <number>
15542 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15543 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15544 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15545
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015546
155476.2.2. Proxy section
15548---------------------
15549
15550http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15551 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15552 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15553 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15554 after this one.
15555
15556http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15557 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15558 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15559 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15560 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15561
15562
15563Example:
15564
15565 backend bck1
15566 mode http
15567
15568 http-request cache-use foobar
15569 http-response cache-store foobar
15570 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15571
15572 cache foobar
15573 total-max-size 4
15574 max-age 240
15575
15576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15578----------------------------------
15579
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015580HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015581client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15582The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15583these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15584but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15585data called patterns.
15586
15587
155887.1. ACL basics
15589---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015590
15591The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15592content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15593from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15594simple :
15595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015596 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015597 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015598 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15599 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015601The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15602adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015603
15604In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015606 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015607
15608This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15609Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15610and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015611an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15612conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15613as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15614are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015615
15616ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15617'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15618which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15619
15620There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15621performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015623The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15624specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15625this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015626methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15627ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015628
15629Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15630 - boolean
15631 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15632 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15633 - string
15634 - data block
15635
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015636Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15637converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15638would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15639The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15640which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15641
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015642Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15643keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15644fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15645which are summarized in the table below :
15646
15647 +---------------------+-----------------+
15648 | Sample or converter | Default |
15649 | output type | matching method |
15650 +---------------------+-----------------+
15651 | boolean | bool |
15652 +---------------------+-----------------+
15653 | integer | int |
15654 +---------------------+-----------------+
15655 | ip | ip |
15656 +---------------------+-----------------+
15657 | string | str |
15658 +---------------------+-----------------+
15659 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15660 +---------------------+-----------------+
15661
15662Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15663matching method, see below.
15664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015665The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15666 - boolean
15667 - integer or integer range
15668 - IP address / network
15669 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15670 - regular expression
15671 - hex block
15672
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015673The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15674
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015675 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15676 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015677 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015678 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015679 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015680 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015681 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015683The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15684read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15685if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15686lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15687will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15688beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015689a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015690lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15691exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15692
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015693The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15694parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15695ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15696a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15697check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15698
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015699The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15700socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15701file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015703Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15704loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15705
15706 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15707
15708In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15709the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15710case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15711as well.
15712
15713The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15714sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15715do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15716methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15717is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015718obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015719followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15720default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15721that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15722string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15723
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015724The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15725By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15726string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15727resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015728server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015729waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015730flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15731function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015733There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15734sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15735be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015736
15737 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15738 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015739 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15740 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15741 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15742 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015743
15744 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15745 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015746 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015747
15748 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015749 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015750
15751 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015752 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015753
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015754 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015755 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15756
15757 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15758 binary or string samples.
15759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015760 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15761 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015763 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15764 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15765 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015767 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15768 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015770 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15771 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015773 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15774 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015776 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15777 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015778 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015780 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15781 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15782 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015783
15784For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15785request, it is possible to do :
15786
15787 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15788
15789In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15790buffer, one would use the following acl :
15791
15792 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15793
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015794On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15795possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15796
15797 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015799All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15800criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15801method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15802to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15803criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15804the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015806If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015807the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15808For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015810 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15811 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15812 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15813 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015814
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015815
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015816The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15817types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15818combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15819brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15820default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015822 +-------------------------------------------------+
15823 | Input sample type |
15824 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015825 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015826 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15827 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15828 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015829 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015830 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015831 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015832 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015833 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015834 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015835 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015836 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015837 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015838 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015839 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015840 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015841 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015842 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015843 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015844 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015845 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015846 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015847 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015848 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015849 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015850 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15851 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15852 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015853
15854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158557.1.1. Matching booleans
15856------------------------
15857
15858In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15859Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15860When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15861that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15862
15863Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15864return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15865"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15866
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158687.1.2. Matching integers
15869------------------------
15870
15871Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15872enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15873to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15874
15875Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15876matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15877lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015878
15879For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15880unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15881representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15882
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015883As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15884two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15885instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15886ranges and operators.
15887
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015888For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015889operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15890Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15891of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015892
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015893Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015894
15895 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15896 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15897 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15898 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15899 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15900
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015901For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015902
15903 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15904
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015905This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15906
15907 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15908
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159107.1.3. Matching strings
15911-----------------------
15912
15913String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15914different forms :
15915
15916 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015917 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015918
15919 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015920 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015921
15922 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15923 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15924
15925 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15926 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15927
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015928 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015929 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15930 matches.
15931
15932 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15933 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15934 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015935
15936String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15937exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15938characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15939string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15940to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015941before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015942
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015943Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15944(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15945Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15946
15947Example:
15948 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15949 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15950
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159527.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15953---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015954
15955Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15956they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15957possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15958passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15959the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015960the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15961match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015962
15963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159647.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15965-------------------------------------
15966
15967It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15968not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15969a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15970to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15971digits may be used upper or lower case.
15972
15973Example :
15974 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15975 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15976
15977
159787.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15979---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015980
15981IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15982netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15983within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015984host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015985difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15986at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15987does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15988parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015989
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015990The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15991abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15992
15993 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15994 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15995 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15996 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15997 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15998 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15999 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
16000 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16001
16002Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
16003192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
16004
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020016005IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
16006Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
16007trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
16008IPv6 patterns.
16009
16010HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
16011following situations :
16012 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
16013 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
16014 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
16015 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
16016 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
16017 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
16018 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
16019 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
16020 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
16021 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
16022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016023
160247.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
16025----------------------------------
16026
16027Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
16028combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
16029
16030 - AND (implicit)
16031 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
16032 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016034A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016036 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016038Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
16039indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016041For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
16042"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
16043requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
16044is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
16045
16046 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016047 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
16048 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
16049 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016050
16051To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
16052and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
16053
16054 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
16055 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
16056 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
16057 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
16058
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016059 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016060 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
16061 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
16062 use_backend www if host_www
16063
16064It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
16065expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
16066be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
16067the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16068
16069 The following rule :
16070
16071 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016072 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016073
16074 Can also be written that way :
16075
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016076 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016077
16078It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16079to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16080simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16081sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16082good use is the following :
16083
16084 With named ACLs :
16085
16086 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16087 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16088 monitor fail if site_dead
16089
16090 With anonymous ACLs :
16091
16092 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16093
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016094See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16095keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016096
16097
160987.3. Fetching samples
16099---------------------
16100
16101Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16102against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16103sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16104ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16105of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16106available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16107
16108This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16109Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16110compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16111deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16112
16113The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16114matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16115method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16116indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16117
16118As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16119when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16120mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16121the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16122ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16123
16124Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16125multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16126when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016127incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16128are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016129is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16130all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16131
16132Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16133 - name
16134 - name(arg1)
16135 - name(arg1,arg2)
16136
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016137
161387.3.1. Converters
16139-----------------
16140
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016141Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16142of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16143is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16144was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016145has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016146unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16147
16148These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16149sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16150the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016151support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016152
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016153A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16154support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16155supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16156(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16157bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016159The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016160
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001616151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16162 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16163 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16164 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16165 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16166 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16167
16168 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016169 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16170 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016171 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16172 frontend http-in
16173 bind *:8081
16174 default_backend servers
16175 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16176 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16177
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016178add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016179 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016180 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016181 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16182 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016183 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016184 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16185 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16186 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16187 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016188 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016189 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016190
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016191aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16192 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16193 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16194 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16195 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16196 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16197 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16198
16199 Example:
16200 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16201 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16202
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016203and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016204 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016205 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016206 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16207 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016208 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016209 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16210 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16211 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16212 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016213 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016214 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016215
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016216b64dec
16217 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16218 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016219 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16220 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016221
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016222base64
16223 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016224 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016225 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16226 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016227
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020016228be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
16229 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
16230 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
16231 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
16232 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
16233 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
16234
16235 Example:
16236 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
16237 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
16238 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
16239 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
16240
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020016241be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
16242 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
16243 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
16244 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
16245 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
16246 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
16247 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
16248
16249 Example:
16250 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
16251 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
16252 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
16253 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
16254
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016255bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016256 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016257 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016258 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016259 presence of a flag).
16260
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016261bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16262 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16263 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016264 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016265
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016266concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16267 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16268 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16269 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16270 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16271 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16272 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16273 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16274 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16275 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16276 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016277 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016278 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016279 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016280 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
16281 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
16282 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016283
16284 Example:
16285 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16286 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16287 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016288 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016289 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016290 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16291
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016292cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016293 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16294 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016295
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016296crc32([<avalanche>])
16297 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16298 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16299 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16300 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16301 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16302 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16303 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16304 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16305 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16306 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016307 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16308
16309crc32c([<avalanche>])
16310 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16311 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16312 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16313 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16314 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16315 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16316 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16317 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016318
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016319cut_crlf
16320 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16321 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16322 updated.
16323
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016324da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016325 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16326 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16327 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16328 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016329 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016330 configuration language.
16331
16332 Example:
16333 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016334 bind *:8881
16335 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016336 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016337
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016338debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16339 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16340 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16341 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16342 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16343 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16344 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16345 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16346 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16347 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16348 printable sample types.
16349
16350 Example:
16351 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016352
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016353digest(<algorithm>)
16354 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16355 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16356
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016357 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016358 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16359
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016360div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016361 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16362 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016363 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016364 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16365 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016366 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016367 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16368 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16369 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16370 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016371 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016372 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016373
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016374djb2([<avalanche>])
16375 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16376 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16377 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16378 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16379 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16380 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16381 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016382 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16383 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016384
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016385even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016386 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016387 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16388
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016389field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16390 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16391 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16392 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16393 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16394 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16395 fields.
16396
16397 Example :
16398 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16399 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16400 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16401 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16402 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016403
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016404fix_is_valid
16405 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16406 Information eXchange):
16407
16408 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16409 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016410 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016411 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016412 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016413 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16414 checksum
16415
16416 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16417 the server can be parsed.
16418
16419 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16420 message, false if not.
16421
16422 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16423
16424 Example:
16425 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16426 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16427
16428fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16429 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16430 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16431 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16432 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016433 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016434 added.
16435
16436 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16437 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16438 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16439 fix_is_valid converter.
16440
16441 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16442
16443 Example:
16444 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16445 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16446 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16447 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16448 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16449
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016450hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016451 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016452 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016453 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016454 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016455
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016456hex2i
16457 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016458 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016459
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016460htonl
16461 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16462 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16463 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16464 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16465
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016466hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016467 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16468 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16469 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16470 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16471
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016472 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016473 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16474
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016475http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016476 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16477 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016478 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16479 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16480 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16481 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16482 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16483 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16484 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16485 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016486
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016487iif(<true>,<false>)
16488 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16489 string otherwise.
16490
16491 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016492 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016493
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016494in_table(<table>)
16495 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16496 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16497 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016498 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016499 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16500
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016501ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016502 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016503 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016504 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16505 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16506 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16507 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16508 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016509
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016510json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016511 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016512 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016513 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016514 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16515 of errors:
16516 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16517 bytes, ...)
16518 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16519 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16520
16521 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16522 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16523 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16524 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16525 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16526 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016527 - "ascii" : never fails;
16528 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16529 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016530 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016531 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016532 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16533 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16534
16535 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016536 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016537
16538 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016539 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016540 capture request header user-agent len 150
16541 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016542
16543 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16544 GET / HTTP/1.0
16545 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16546
16547 Output log:
16548 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16549
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016550json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16551 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16552 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16553 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16554 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16555
16556 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16557 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16558
16559 Example:
16560 # get a integer value from the request body
16561 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16562 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16563
16564 # get a key with '.' in the name
16565 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16566 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16567
16568 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16569 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16570
16571 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16572 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16573
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016574language(<value>[,<default>])
16575 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16576 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16577 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16578 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16579 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16580 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16581 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16582 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16583 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016584 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016585 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16586 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016587
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016588 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016589
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016590 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16591 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016592
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016593 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16594 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16595 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16596 use_backend spanish if es
16597 use_backend french if fr
16598 use_backend english if en
16599 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016600
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016601length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016602 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16603 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16604 type. The result is of type integer.
16605
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016606lower
16607 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16608 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16609 type. The result is of type string.
16610
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016611ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16612 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16613 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16614 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16615 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16616 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16617 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16618
16619 Example :
16620
16621 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016622 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016623 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16624
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016625ltrim(<chars>)
16626 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16627 representation of the input sample.
16628
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016629map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16630map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16631map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16632 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16633 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16634 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16635 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16636 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16637 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16638 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16639 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016640
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016641 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16642 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16643 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016644
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016645 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016646 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016647
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016648 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16649 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16650 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16651 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016652 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16653 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016654 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16655 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16656 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16657 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16658 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16659 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16660 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16661 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016662 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16663 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16664 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016665 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16666 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16667 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16668 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16669 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016670
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016671 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16672 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16673 the corresponding match text.
16674
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016675 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16676 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16677 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16678 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16679 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016680
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016681 Example :
16682
16683 # this is a comment and is ignored
16684 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16685 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16686 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16687 | | | `---------- value
16688 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16689 | `---------------------------- key
16690 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16691
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016692mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016693 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16694 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016695 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016696 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016697 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016698 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16699 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16700 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16701 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016702 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016703 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016704
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016705mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016706 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16707 <packettype>.
16708 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16709 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16710 from.
16711 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16712 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16713 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16714
16715 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16716 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16717 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16718 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16719
16720 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16721 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16722 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16723 packets only):
16724 17: Session Expiry Interval
16725 33: Receive Maximum
16726 39: Maximum Packet Size
16727 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16728 25: Request Response Information
16729 23: Request Problem Information
16730 21: Authentication Method
16731 22: Authentication Data
16732 18: Will Delay Interval
16733 1: Payload Format Indicator
16734 2: Message Expiry Interval
16735 3: Content Type
16736 8: Response Topic
16737 9: Correlation Data
16738 Not supported yet:
16739 38: User Property
16740
16741 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16742 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16743 packets only):
16744 17: Session Expiry Interval
16745 33: Receive Maximum
16746 36: Maximum QoS
16747 37: Retain Available
16748 39: Maximum Packet Size
16749 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16750 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16751 31: Reason String
16752 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16753 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16754 42: Shared Subscription Available
16755 19: Server Keep Alive
16756 26: Response Information
16757 28: Server Reference
16758 21: Authentication Method
16759 22: Authentication Data
16760 Not supported yet:
16761 38: User Property
16762
16763 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16764 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16765 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16766 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16767
16768 Example:
16769
16770 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16771 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16772 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16773 if data_in_buffer
16774 # do the same as above
16775 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16776 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16777 if data_in_buffer
16778
16779mqtt_is_valid
16780 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16781
16782 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16783 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16784 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16785 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16786
16787 Example:
16788
16789 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016790 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016791
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016792mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016793 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016794 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16795 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016796 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016797 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016798 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016799 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16800 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16801 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16802 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016803 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016804 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016805
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016806nbsrv
16807 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16808 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16809 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16810 map lookup.
16811
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016812neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016813 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16814 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16815 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16816 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016817
16818not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016819 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016820 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016821 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016822 absence of a flag).
16823
16824odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016825 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016826 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16827
16828or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016829 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016830 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016831 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16832 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016833 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016834 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16835 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16836 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16837 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016838 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016839 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016840
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016841protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16842 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16843 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16844 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16845 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16846 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16847 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16848 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16849 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16850 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16851 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16852 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16853
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016854regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016855 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16856 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16857 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16858 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16859 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16860 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16861 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16862 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16863 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016864 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16865 of characters with other ones.
16866
16867 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16868 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16869 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16870 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16871 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16872 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016873
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016874 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016875
16876 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16877 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16878 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016879 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016880
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016881 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16882 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16883
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016884 # capture groups and backreferences
16885 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016886 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016887 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16888
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016889capture-req(<id>)
16890 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16891 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16892
16893 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016894 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16895 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016896
16897capture-res(<id>)
16898 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16899 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16900
16901 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016902 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16903 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016904
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016905rtrim(<chars>)
16906 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16907 of the input sample.
16908
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016909sdbm([<avalanche>])
16910 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16911 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16912 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16913 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16914 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16915 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16916 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016917 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16918 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016919
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016920secure_memcmp(<var>)
16921 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16922 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16923 match.
16924
16925 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16926 performed in constant time.
16927
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016928 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016929 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16930
16931 Example :
16932
16933 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16934 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16935 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16936 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16937
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016938set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016939 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16940 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16941 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016942 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016943 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16944 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016945 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016946 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16947 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016948 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016949 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016950
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016951sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016952 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016953 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16954
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016955sha2([<bits>])
16956 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16957 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16958
16959 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16960 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16961
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016962 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016963 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16964
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016965srv_queue
16966 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16967 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16968 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16969 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16970 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16971
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016972strcmp(<var>)
16973 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16974 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16975 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16976 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16977 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16978 shorter).
16979
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016980 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16981 strings in constant time.
16982
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016983 Example :
16984
16985 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16986 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16987 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16988
16989
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016990sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016991 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16992 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016993 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016994 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16995 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016996 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016997 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16998 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016999 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017000 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17001 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017002 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017003 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017004
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017005table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
17006 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17007 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17008 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
17009 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17010 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17011 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
17012
17013
17014table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
17015 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17016 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17017 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
17018 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17019 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17020 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
17021
17022table_conn_cnt(<table>)
17023 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17024 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017025 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017026 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
17027 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17028
17029table_conn_cur(<table>)
17030 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17031 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17032 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17033 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17034 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
17035
17036table_conn_rate(<table>)
17037 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17038 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17039 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
17040 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17041 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
17042
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020017043table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
17044 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17045 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17046 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
17047 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
17048 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17049 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17050 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
17051 data-type).
17052 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
17053
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017054table_gpt0(<table>)
17055 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17056 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17057 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17058 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17059 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
17060
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020017061table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
17062 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17063 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17064 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
17065 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
17066 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
17067 between 0 and 99.
17068 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17069 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
17070 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
17071 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
17072
17073table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
17074 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17075 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17076 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
17077 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
17078 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
17079 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17080 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
17081 value 0.
17082 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
17083 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
17084 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
17085
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017086table_gpc0(<table>)
17087 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17088 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17089 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17090 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17091 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
17092
17093table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
17094 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17095 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17096 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
17097 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17098 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
17099 sample fetch keyword.
17100
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017101table_gpc1(<table>)
17102 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17103 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17104 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
17105 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17106 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
17107
17108table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
17109 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17110 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17111 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
17112 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17113 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
17114 sample fetch keyword.
17115
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017116table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
17117 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17118 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017119 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017120 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17121 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17122
17123table_http_err_rate(<table>)
17124 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17125 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17126 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17127 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17128 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17129 keyword.
17130
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017131table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17132 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17133 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17134 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17135 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17136 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17137
17138table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17139 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17140 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17141 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17142 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17143 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17144 keyword.
17145
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017146table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17147 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17148 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017149 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017150 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17151 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17152
17153table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17154 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17155 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17156 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17157 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17158 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17159 keyword.
17160
17161table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17162 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17163 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017164 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017165 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17166 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17167 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17168 keyword.
17169
17170table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17171 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17172 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017173 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017174 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17175 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17176 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17177 keyword.
17178
17179table_server_id(<table>)
17180 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17181 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17182 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17183 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17184 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17185 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17186
17187table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17188 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17189 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017190 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017191 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17192 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17193 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17194 keyword.
17195
17196table_sess_rate(<table>)
17197 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17198 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17199 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17200 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17201 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17202 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17203 keyword.
17204
17205table_trackers(<table>)
17206 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17207 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17208 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17209 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17210 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17211 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17212 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17213 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17214 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17215 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17216
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017217ub64dec
17218 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17219 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17220 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17221
17222 Example:
17223 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17224 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17225
17226ub64enc
17227 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17228
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017229upper
17230 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17231 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17232 type. The result is of type string.
17233
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017234url_dec([<in_form>])
17235 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17236 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17237 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17238 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17239 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17240 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017241
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017242url_enc([<enc_type>])
17243 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17244 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17245 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17246 optional argument is here for future changes.
17247
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017248ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017249 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017250 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17251 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17252 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017253 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17254 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17255 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17256 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017257 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017258 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17259 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017260
17261 Example:
17262 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17263 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17264
17265 message Point {
17266 int32 latitude = 1;
17267 int32 longitude = 2;
17268 }
17269
17270 message PPoint {
17271 Point point = 59;
17272 }
17273
17274 message Rectangle {
17275 // One corner of the rectangle.
17276 PPoint lo = 48;
17277 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17278 PPoint hi = 49;
17279 }
17280
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017281 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17282 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17283 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017284
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017285 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17286 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017287 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017288 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17289
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017290 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017291
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017292 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017293
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017294 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17295 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17296 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017297
17298 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17299 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17300 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17301
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017302 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17303 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17304 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017305
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017306
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017307unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017308 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17309 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17310 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17311 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17312 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17313 response),
17314 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17315 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17316 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17317 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17318
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017319utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17320 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17321 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17322 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17323 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17324 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17325 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17326
17327 Example :
17328
17329 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017330 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017331 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17332
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017333word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17334 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17335 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17336 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017337 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017338 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17339 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17340
17341 Example :
17342 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17343 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17344 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17345 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17346 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017347 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017348
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017349wt6([<avalanche>])
17350 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17351 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17352 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17353 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17354 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17355 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17356 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017357 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17358 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017359
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017360xor(<value>)
17361 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017362 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017363 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017364 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017365 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017366 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17367 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017368 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017369 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17370 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017371 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017372 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017373
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017374xxh3([<seed>])
17375 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17376 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17377 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17378 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17379 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17380 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17381 considered as cryptographically secure.
17382
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017383xxh32([<seed>])
17384 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17385 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17386 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17387 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17388 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17389 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17390 as cryptographically secure.
17391
17392xxh64([<seed>])
17393 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17394 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17395 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17396 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17397 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17398 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17399 as cryptographically secure.
17400
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017401
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200174027.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017403--------------------------------------------
17404
17405A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17406not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17407"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17408The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17409
17410always_false : boolean
17411 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17412 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17413
17414always_true : boolean
17415 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17416 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17417
17418avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017419 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017420 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17421 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17422 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17423 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17424 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17425 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17426 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17427 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17428 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17429 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17430 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17431 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17432 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017434be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017435 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17436 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17437 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17438 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017439 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17440
17441be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17442 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17443 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17444 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17445 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17446 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017447 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17448 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017449
17450 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17451 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17452 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017454be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17455 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17456 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17457 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017458 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017459 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17460 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017461
17462 Example :
17463 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17464 backend dynamic
17465 mode http
17466 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17467 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017468
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017469bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017470 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17471 of the string.
17472
17473bool(<bool>) : bool
17474 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17475 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017477connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17478 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017479 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017480 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17481 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017482
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017483 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017484 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017485 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17486
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017487 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17488 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017489
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017490 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017491 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017492 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017493 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017494 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017495 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017496 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017497
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017498 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17499 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017500 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017501 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017502
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017503cpu_calls : integer
17504 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17505 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17506 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17507 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17508 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17509 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17510
17511cpu_ns_avg : integer
17512 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17513 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17514 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17515 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17516 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17517 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17518 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17519 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17520 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17521 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17522 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17523
17524cpu_ns_tot : integer
17525 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17526 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17527 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17528 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17529 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17530 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17531 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17532 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17533 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17534 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17535 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17536 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17537 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17538
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017539date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017540 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017541
17542 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17543 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17544 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017545 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17546
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017547 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17548 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17549 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17550 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17551 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17552
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017553 Example :
17554
17555 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17556 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017557
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017558 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17559 # millisecond granularity
17560 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17561
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017562date_us : integer
17563 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17564 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17565 from the same timeval structure.
17566
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017567distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17568 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17569 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17570 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17571 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017572 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017573 list of supported tokens.
17574
17575distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17576 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17577 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17578 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17579 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017580 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017581 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17582 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17583 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17584 supported tokens.
17585
17586 Example :
17587 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17588 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17589 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17590 # send large files to the big farm
17591 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17592
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017593env(<name>) : string
17594 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17595 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17596 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17597 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17598 certain way.
17599
17600 Examples :
17601 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17602 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17603
17604 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17605 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017607fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17608 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017609 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17610 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017611 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17612 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017613 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017614 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17615 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017616
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017617fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17618 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17619 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17620 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017622fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17623 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17624 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17625 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17626 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17627 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17628 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17629 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17630 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017631
17632 Example :
17633 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17634 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17635 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17636 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17637 frontend mail
17638 bind :25
17639 mode tcp
17640 maxconn 100
17641 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17642 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17643 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17644 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017645
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017646hostname : string
17647 Returns the system hostname.
17648
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017649int(<integer>) : signed integer
17650 Returns a signed integer.
17651
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017652ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17653 Returns an ipv4.
17654
17655ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17656 Returns an ipv6.
17657
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017658lat_ns_avg : integer
17659 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17660 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17661 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17662 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17663 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17664 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17665 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17666 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17667 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017668 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17669 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17670 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17671 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17672 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17673 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017674
17675lat_ns_tot : integer
17676 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17677 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17678 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17679 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17680 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17681 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17682 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17683 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17684 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017685 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17686 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17687 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17688 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17689 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017690 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17691 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17692 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17693 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17694 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17695 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17696
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017697meth(<method>) : method
17698 Returns a method.
17699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017700nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17701 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17702 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17703 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017704 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17705 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17706 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017707
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017708prio_class : integer
17709 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17710 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17711 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17712
17713prio_offset : integer
17714 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17715 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17716 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17717 set-priority-offset".
17718
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017719proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020017720 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
17721 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017723queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017724 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17725 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17726 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017727 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17728 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17729 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17730 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17731 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17732
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017733rand([<range>]) : integer
17734 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17735 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17736 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17737 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17738 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017740srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17741 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17742 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17743 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17744 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17745 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017746 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17747 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17748
17749srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17750 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17751 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17752 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17753 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17754 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17755 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17756 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17757
17758 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17759 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017760
17761srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17762 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17763 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17764 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017765 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017766 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17767 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17768 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17769
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017770srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17771 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17772 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17773 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17774 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17775 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17776 fetch methods.
17777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017778srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17779 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17780 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017781 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017782 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17783 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017784 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017785 overloading servers).
17786
17787 Example :
17788 # Redirect to a separate back
17789 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17790 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17791 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17792
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017793srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017794 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17795 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17796 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17797
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017798srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017799 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17800 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17801 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17802
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017803srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017804 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17805 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17806 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17807
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017808stopping : boolean
17809 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17810 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17811 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17812
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017813str(<string>) : string
17814 Returns a string.
17815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017816table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17817 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17818 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17819
17820table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17821 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17822 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17823 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17824
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017825thread : integer
17826 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17827 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17828 and debugging purposes.
17829
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017830uuid([<version>]) : string
17831 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17832 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17833 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17834
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020017835var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017836 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020017837 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
17838 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
17839 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017840 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017841 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17842 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017843 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017844 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17845 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017846 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017847 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017848
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200178497.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017850----------------------------------
17851
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017852The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017853closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17854methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17855sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17856TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017857the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17858counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017859"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17860used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17861can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17862Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17863table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17864tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17865currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017866
Remi Tricot-Le Breton942c1672021-09-01 15:52:15 +020017867bc_conn_err : integer
17868 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
17869 connection. See the "fc_conn_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
17870 and their corresponding error message.
17871
17872bc_conn_err_str : string
17873 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
17874 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
17875 "fc_conn_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
17876 corresponding error message.
17877
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017878bc_dst : ip
17879 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17880 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17881 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17882 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17883
17884bc_dst_port : integer
17885 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017886 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017887
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017888bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017889 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17890 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17891 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17892
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017893bc_src : ip
17894 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017895 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017896 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17897 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17898
17899bc_src_port : integer
17900 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017901 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017903be_id : integer
17904 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017905 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17906 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017907
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017908be_name : string
17909 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017910 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17911 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017912
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017913be_server_timeout : integer
17914 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17915 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17916 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17917
17918be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17919 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17920 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17921 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17922
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017923cur_server_timeout : integer
17924 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17925 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17926 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17927
17928cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17929 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17930 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17931 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017933dst : ip
17934 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17935 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17936 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17937 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017938 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17939 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17940 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17941 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17942 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17943 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017944
17945dst_conn : integer
17946 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17947 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17948 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17949 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17950 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17951 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17952 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17953 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017954
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017955dst_is_local : boolean
17956 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17957 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17958 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17959 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017960 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017961 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17962 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17963 it only once per connection.
17964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017965dst_port : integer
17966 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17967 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17968 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17969 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17970 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17971 an HTTP header.
17972
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020017973fc_conn_err : integer
17974 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
17975 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
17976 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050017977 described in section 8.2.5). See the "fc_conn_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020017978 error codes and their corresponding error message.
17979
17980fc_conn_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050017981 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020017982 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
17983 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.5). See below for a
17984 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
17985
17986 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17987 | ID | message |
17988 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17989 | 0 | "Success" |
17990 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
17991 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
17992 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
17993 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
17994 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
17995 | 6 | "General socket error" |
17996 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
17997 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
17998 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
17999 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
18000 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18001 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18002 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18003 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
18004 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
18005 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
18006 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
18007 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18008 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18009 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
18010 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
18011 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
18012 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
18013 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
18014 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
18015 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
18016 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
18017 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
18018 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
18019 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
18020 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
18021 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
18022 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
18023 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
18024 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
18025 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
18026 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
18027 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
18028 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
18029 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
18030 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
18031 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
18032 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18033
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020018034fc_http_major : integer
18035 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18036 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18037 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
18038
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020018039fc_pp_authority : string
18040 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18041 if any.
18042
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010018043fc_pp_unique_id : string
18044 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18045 if any.
18046
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010018047fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
18048 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
18049 header.
18050
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020018051fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
18052 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
18053 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
18054 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
18055 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18056 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18057 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18058
18059fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
18060 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
18061 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
18062 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
18063 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18064 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18065 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18066
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018067fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018068 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18069 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18070 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18071 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18072
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018073fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018074 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18075 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18076 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18077 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18078
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018079fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018080 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
18081 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18082 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18083 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18084
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018085fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018086 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
18087 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18088 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18089 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18090
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018091fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018092 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
18093 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18094 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18095 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18096
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018097fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018098 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
18099 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18100 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18101 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18102
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020018103fe_defbe : string
18104 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
18105 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
18106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018107fe_id : integer
18108 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010018109 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018110 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18111
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018112fe_name : string
18113 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
18114 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
18115 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18116
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010018117fe_client_timeout : integer
18118 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
18119 current frontend.
18120
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018121sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018122sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18123sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18124sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018125 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
18126 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18127 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
18128
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018129sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018130sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18131sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18132sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018133 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
18134 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18135 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
18136
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018137sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18138 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18139 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18140 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18141 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18142 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18143 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18144 will always return zero.
18145 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18146 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18147
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018148sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018149sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18150sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18151sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018152 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18153 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018154 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18155 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18156 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018157
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018158 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018159 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18160 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018161 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18162 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18163 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018164 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18165 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18166
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018167sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18168sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18169sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18170sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18171 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18172 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18173 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18174 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18175 when a first ACL was verified.
18176
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018177sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018178sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18179sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18180sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018181 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018182 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18183
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018184sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018185sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18186sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18187sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018188 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18189 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18190 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18191
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018192sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018193sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18194sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18195sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018196 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18197 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18198 See also src_conn_rate.
18199
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018200sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18201 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
18202 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
18203 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
18204 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18205 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
18206 index, zero is returned.
18207 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18208 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
18209
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018210sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018211sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18212sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18213sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018214 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018215 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018216
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018217sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18218sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18219sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18220sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18221 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18222 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18223
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018224sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18225 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18226 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
18227 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18228 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18229 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
18230 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
18231 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
18232
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018233sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18234sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18235sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18236sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18237 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18238 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18239
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018240sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18241 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18242 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
18243 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
18244 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
18245 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
18246 between 0 and 2.
18247 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
18248 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18249 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18250 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18251 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18252
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018253sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018254sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18255sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18256sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018257 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18258 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18259 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018260 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18261 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18262 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018263
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018264sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18265sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18266sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18267sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18268 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18269 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18270 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18271 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18272 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18273 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18274
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018275sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018276sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18277sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18278sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018279 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018280 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18281 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18282
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018283sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018284sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18285sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18286sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018287 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18288 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18289 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18290 src_http_err_rate.
18291
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018292sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18293sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18294sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18295sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18296 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18297 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18298 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18299
18300sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18301sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18302sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18303sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18304 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18305 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18306 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18307 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18308
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018309sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018310sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18311sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18312sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018313 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018314 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18315 src_http_req_cnt.
18316
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018317sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018318sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18319sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18320sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018321 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18322 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18323 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18324 src_http_req_rate.
18325
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018326sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18327 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18328 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18329 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18330 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18331 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18332 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18333 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
18334 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18335 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18336
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018337sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018338sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18339sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18340sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018341 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018342 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18343 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18344 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18345 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018346
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018347 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018348 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18349 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018350 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18351
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018352sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18353sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18354sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18355sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18356 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18357 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18358 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18359 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18360 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18361
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018362sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018363sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18364sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18365sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018366 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18367 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18368 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018369
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018370sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018371sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18372sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18373sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018374 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18375 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18376 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018377
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018378sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018379sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18380sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18381sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018382 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018383 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18384 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18385 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018386 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018387 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18388
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018389sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018390sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18391sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18392sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018393 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18394 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18395 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18396 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18397 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018398 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018399
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018400sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018401sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18402sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18403sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018404 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18405 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18406 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18407
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018408sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018409sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18410sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18411sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018412 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18413 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018414 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018415 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18416 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018417 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18418 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18419 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018421so_id : integer
18422 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18423 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18424 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018425
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018426so_name : string
18427 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18428 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18429 strings instead of integers.
18430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018431src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018432 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018433 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18434 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18435 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018436 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18437 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18438 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018439 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18440 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18441 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18442 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18443 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18444 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18445 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018446
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018447 Example:
18448 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18449 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018451src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18452 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18453 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18454 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018455 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018457src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18458 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18459 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018460 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018461 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018462
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018463src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18464 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18465 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18466 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
18467 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18468 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
18469 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18470 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18471 See also sc_clr_gpc.
18472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018473src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18474 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18475 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18476 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18477 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18478 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18479 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018480
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018481 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018482 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18483 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18484 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18485 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018486 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018487 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18488 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18489
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018490src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18491 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18492 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18493 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18494 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18495 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18496 was verified.
18497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018498src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018499 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018500 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018501 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018502 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018504src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018505 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018506 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18507 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018508 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018510src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18511 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18512 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18513 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018514 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018515
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018516src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18517 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
18518 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18519 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18520 is an integer between 0 and 99.
18521 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
18522 is returned.
18523 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
18524 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18525 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
18526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018527src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018528 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018529 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018530 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018531 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018532
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018533src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18534 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18535 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18536 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18537 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18538
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018539src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18540 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18541 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18542 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
18543 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18544 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
18545 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18546
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018547src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18548 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18549 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18550 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18551 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18552
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018553src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18554 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18555 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
18556 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18557 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
18558 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18559 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
18560 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18561 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18562 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18563 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018565src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018566 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018567 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018568 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18569 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018570 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18571 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18572 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018573
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018574src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18575 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18576 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18577 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18578 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18579 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18580 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18581 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018583src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018584 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018585 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018586 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018587 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018588 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018590src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18591 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18592 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18593 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18594 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018595 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018596
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018597src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18598 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18599 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018600 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018601 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18602 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18603
18604src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18605 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18606 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18607 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18608 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18609 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18610 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018612src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018613 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018614 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18615 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018616 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018618src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18619 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18620 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18621 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018622 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018623 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018624
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018625src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18626 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
18627 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18628 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
18629 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18630 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
18631 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18632 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18633 See also sc_inc_gpc.
18634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018635src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18636 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18637 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18638 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018639 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018640 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18641 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018642
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018643 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018644 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018645 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018646 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018647
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018648src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18649 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18650 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18651 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18652 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18653 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18654 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18655
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018656src_is_local : boolean
18657 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18658 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18659 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18660 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018661 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018662 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18663 once per connection.
18664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018665src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018666 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18667 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18668 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18669 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18670 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018672src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018673 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18674 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18675 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18676 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18677 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018679src_port : integer
18680 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18681 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18682 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18683 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018685src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018686 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018687 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18688 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18689 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018690 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018692src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18693 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18694 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18695 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18696 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018697 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018699src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18700 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18701 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18702 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18703 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18704 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18705 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18706 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18707 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018708
18709 Example :
18710 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18711 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18712 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18713 listen ssh
18714 bind :22
18715 mode tcp
18716 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018717 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018718 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018719 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018721srv_id : integer
18722 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18723 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018724 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018725
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018726srv_name : string
18727 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18728 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018729 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018730
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200187317.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018732----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018733
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018734The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018735closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18736when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18737usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018738future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018739
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001874051d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18741 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18742 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18743 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18744 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18745 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18746
18747 Example :
18748 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18749 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18750 # the request.
18751 frontend http-in
18752 bind *:8081
18753 default_backend servers
18754 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18755 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18756
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018757ssl_bc : boolean
18758 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18759 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018760 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18761 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018762
18763ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18764 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018765 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18766 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018767
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018768ssl_bc_alpn : string
18769 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18770 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018771 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018772 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18773 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18774 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18775 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18776 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018777 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18778 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018779
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018780ssl_bc_cipher : string
18781 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018782 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18783 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018784
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018785ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18786 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18787 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18788 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018789 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018790
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020018791ssl_bc_hsk_err : integer
18792 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18793 returns the ID of the latest error that happened during the handshake on the
18794 backend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. In order to get a text
18795 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_hsk_err_str"
18796 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
18797 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
18798 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
18799
18800ssl_bc_hsk_err_str : string
18801 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18802 returns a string representation of the latest error that happened during the
18803 handshake on the backend side. See also "ssl_fc_hsk_err".
18804
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018805ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18806 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18807 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018808 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18809 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018810
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018811ssl_bc_npn : string
18812 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18813 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018814 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018815 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18816 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18817 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18818 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018819 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18820 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018821
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018822ssl_bc_protocol : string
18823 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018824 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18825 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018826
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018827ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018828 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018829 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018830 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18831 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018832
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018833ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18834 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18835 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18836 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018837 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018838
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018839ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18840 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18841 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018842 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18843 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018844
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018845ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18846 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18847 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18848 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018849 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018850
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018851ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18852 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018853 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18854 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018856ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18857 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18858 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18859 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18860 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18861 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018863ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18864 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18865 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18866 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18867 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018868
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018869ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018870 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18871 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18872 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018873 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018874 does not support resumed sessions.
18875
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018876ssl_c_der : binary
18877 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18878 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18879 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018881ssl_c_err : integer
18882 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18883 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18884 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18885 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18886 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018887
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018888ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018889 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18890 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18891 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18892 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18893 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18894 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18895 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18896 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018897 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18898 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18899 LDAP v3.
18900 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18901 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018903ssl_c_key_alg : string
18904 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18905 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18906 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018908ssl_c_notafter : string
18909 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18910 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18911 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018913ssl_c_notbefore : string
18914 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18915 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18916 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018917
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018918ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018919 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18920 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18921 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18922 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18923 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18924 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18925 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18926 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018927 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18928 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18929 LDAP v3.
18930 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18931 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018933ssl_c_serial : binary
18934 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18935 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18936 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018938ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18939 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18940 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18941 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018942 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18943 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18944
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018945 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018946 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018948ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18949 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18950 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18951 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018953ssl_c_used : boolean
18954 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18955 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018957ssl_c_verify : integer
18958 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18959 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18960 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18961 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018963ssl_c_version : integer
18964 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18965 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018966
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018967ssl_f_der : binary
18968 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18969 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18970 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18971
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018972ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018973 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18974 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18975 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18976 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018977 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018978 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18979 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18980 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018981 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18982 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18983 LDAP v3.
18984 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18985 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018987ssl_f_key_alg : string
18988 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18989 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18990 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018992ssl_f_notafter : string
18993 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18994 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18995 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018997ssl_f_notbefore : string
18998 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18999 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19000 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019001
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019002ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019003 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19004 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19005 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19006 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19007 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19008 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19009 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19010 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019011 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19012 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19013 LDAP v3.
19014 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19015 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019017ssl_f_serial : binary
19018 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19019 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19020 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019021
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020019022ssl_f_sha1 : binary
19023 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
19024 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19025 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019027ssl_f_sig_alg : string
19028 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19029 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19030 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019032ssl_f_version : integer
19033 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19034 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19035
19036ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019037 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
19038 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
19039 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
19040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019041 Example :
19042 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
19043 listen http-https
19044 bind :80
19045 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
19046 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
19047
19048ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
19049 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
19050 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19051
19052ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019053 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019054 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019055 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019056 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
19057 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
19058 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
19059 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
19060 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
19061 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
19062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019063ssl_fc_cipher : string
19064 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
19065 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020019066
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019067ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19068 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
19069 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019070 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019071 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19072 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19073 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019074
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019075 Example:
19076 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19077 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19078 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19079 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19080 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19081 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19082 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19083 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19084 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19085
19086ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019087 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019088 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019089 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
19090 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019091 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19092 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019093
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019094ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019095 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019096 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019097 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019098 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19099 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19100 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19101 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
19102 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
19103 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019104
19105ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019106 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019107 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
19108 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019109
19110ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
19111 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
19112 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019113 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019114
19115 Example:
19116 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19117 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19118 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19119 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19120 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19121 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19122 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19123 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19124 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19125
19126ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19127 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
19128 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019129 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019130 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19131 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
19132 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19133
19134 Example:
19135 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19136 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19137 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19138 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19139 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19140 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19141 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19142 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19143 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19144
19145ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19146 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
19147 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019148 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019149 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19150 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
19151 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19152
19153 Example:
19154 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19155 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19156 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19157 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19158 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19159 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19160 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19161 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19162 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019163
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019164ssl_fc_client_random : binary
19165 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19166 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19167 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19168
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019169ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
19170 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19171 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19172 transport layer.
19173 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19174 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19175 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19176 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19177
19178ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19179 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19180 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19181 transport layer.
19182 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19183 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19184 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19185 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19186
19187ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
19188 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19189 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19190 transport layer.
19191 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19192 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19193 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19194 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19195
19196ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
19197 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19198 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19199 transport layer.
19200 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19201 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19202 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19203 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19204
19205ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
19206 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19207 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19208 transport layer.
19209 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19210 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19211 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19212 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019214ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019215 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
19216 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010019217 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
19218 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
19219 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
19220 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019221
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020019222ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
19223 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
19224 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
19225 wait until the handshake happened.
19226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019227ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
19228 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019229 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
19230 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019231 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019232 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019233
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c6898e2021-07-29 09:45:51 +020019234ssl_fc_hsk_err : integer
19235 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19236 returns the ID of the latest error that happened during the handshake on the
19237 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. Any error happening during
19238 the client's certificate verification process will not be raised through this
19239 fetch but via the existing "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and
19240 "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get a text description of this
19241 error code, you can either use the "ssl_fc_hsk_err_str" sample fetch or use
19242 the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code in hexadecimal
19243 representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL library's
19244 documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
19245
19246ssl_fc_hsk_err_str : string
19247 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19248 returns a string representation of the latest error that happened during the
19249 handshake on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
19250 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
19251 also "ssl_fc_hsk_err".
19252
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020019253ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019254 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010019255 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
19256 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019258ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019259 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019260 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019261 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
19262 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
19263 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
19264 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
19265 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
19266 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020019267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019268ssl_fc_protocol : string
19269 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
19270 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019271
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019272ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
19273 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
19274 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019275 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
19276 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019277
19278 Example:
19279 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19280 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19281 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19282 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19283 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19284 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19285 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19286 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19287 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19288
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019289ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019290 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019291 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
19292 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019293
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019294ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19295 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19296 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19297 transport layer.
19298 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19299 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19300 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19301 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19302
19303ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
19304 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19305 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19306 transport layer.
19307 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19308 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19309 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19310 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19311
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019312ssl_fc_server_random : binary
19313 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19314 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19315 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019317ssl_fc_session_id : binary
19318 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
19319 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
19320 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
19321 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019322
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019323ssl_fc_session_key : binary
19324 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
19325 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19326 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
19327 BoringSSL.
19328
19329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019330ssl_fc_sni : string
19331 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
19332 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019333 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019334 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
19335 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
19336
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019337 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019338 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019339 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019340 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020019341 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019343 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019344 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
19345 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020019346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019347ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
19348 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
19349 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019350
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019351ssl_s_der : binary
19352 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
19353 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19354 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19355
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019356ssl_s_chain_der : binary
19357 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
19358 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19359 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019360 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019361 does not support resumed sessions.
19362
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019363ssl_s_key_alg : string
19364 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19365 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19366 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19367
19368ssl_s_notafter : string
19369 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19370 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19371 transport layer.
19372
19373ssl_s_notbefore : string
19374 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19375 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19376 transport layer.
19377
19378ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19379 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19380 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19381 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19382 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19383 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19384 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019385 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19386 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019387 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19388 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19389 LDAP v3.
19390 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19391 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19392
19393ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19394 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19395 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19396 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19397 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19398 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19399 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019400 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19401 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019402 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19403 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19404 LDAP v3.
19405 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19406 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19407
19408ssl_s_serial : binary
19409 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19410 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19411 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19412
19413ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19414 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19415 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19416 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19417
19418ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19419 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19420 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19421 layer.
19422
19423ssl_s_version : integer
19424 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19425 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019426
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200194277.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019428------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019430Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19431sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19432only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19433For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19434be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19435can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19436sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19437for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19438content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019439
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019440Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19441 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019442 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019443 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19444 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19445 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19446 sample expression). So be careful.
19447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019448payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019449 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019450 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19451 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019453payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19454 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019455 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019456 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019458req.len : integer
19459req_len : integer (deprecated)
19460 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19461 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19462 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19463 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19464 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019465 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019466 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19467 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019469req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19470 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019471 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19472 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19473 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19474 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019476 ACL alternatives :
19477 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019479req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19480 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19481 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19482 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19483 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019485 ACL alternatives :
19486 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019488 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019490req.proto_http : boolean
19491req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19492 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19493 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19494 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19495 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19496 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19497 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19498 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019500 Example:
19501 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19502 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19503 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019504 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019506req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19507rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19508 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19509 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19510 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19511 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19512 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19513 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19514 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019516 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19517 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19518 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19519 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19520 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19521 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019523 ACL derivatives :
19524 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019526 Example :
19527 listen tse-farm
19528 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19529 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19530 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19531 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19532 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19533 persist rdp-cookie
19534 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19535 # This is only useful makes sense if
19536 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19537 stick-table type string size 204800
19538 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19539 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19540 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019542 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
19543 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019545req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19546rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19547 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19548 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19549 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19550 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019552 ACL derivatives :
19553 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019554
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019555req.ssl_alpn : string
19556 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19557 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19558 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19559 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19560 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19561 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019562 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019563
19564 Examples :
19565 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19566 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19567 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019568 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019569 default_backend bk_default
19570
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019571req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19572 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19573 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019574 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19575 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19576 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19577 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19578 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019580req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19581req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19582 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19583 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19584 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19585 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19586 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19587 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19588 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019590req.ssl_sni : string
19591req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19592 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19593 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19594 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19595 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19596 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019597 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19598 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19599 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19600 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19601 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19602 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19603 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19604 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19605 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019607 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019608 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019610 Examples :
19611 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19612 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19613 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019614 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019615 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019616
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019617req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19618 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19619 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19620 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19621 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19622 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19623 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19624 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19625 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19626 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019628req.ssl_ver : integer
19629req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19630 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19631 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19632 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19633 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19634 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19635 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19636 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019637 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019638 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019640 ACL derivatives :
19641 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019642
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019643res.len : integer
19644 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19645 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19646 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19647 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19648 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019649 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019650 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019651 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019653res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19654 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019655 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019656 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019657 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019658 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019660res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19661 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19662 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19663 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019664 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19665 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019667 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019668
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019669res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19670rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19671 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19672 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19673 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19674 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19675 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19676 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19677 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019679wait_end : boolean
19680 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19681 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019682 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019683 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19684 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019685 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019686 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19687 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019689 Examples :
19690 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19691 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19692 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019694 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19695 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19696 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19697 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19698 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19699 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19700 tcp-request content reject
19701
19702
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200197037.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019704--------------------------------------
19705
19706It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19707This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19708data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19709its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19710HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19711content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19712to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19713more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19714response are indexed.
19715
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019716Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19717 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19718 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19719 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19720 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19721 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19722 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019724base : string
19725 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19726 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19727 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19728 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19729 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19730 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19731 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19732 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19733
19734 ACL derivatives :
19735 base : exact string match
19736 base_beg : prefix match
19737 base_dir : subdir match
19738 base_dom : domain match
19739 base_end : suffix match
19740 base_len : length match
19741 base_reg : regex match
19742 base_sub : substring match
19743
19744base32 : integer
19745 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19746 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19747 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019748 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19749 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19750 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019751
19752base32+src : binary
19753 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19754 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19755 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19756 per-URL counters.
19757
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019758baseq : string
19759 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19760 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19761 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19762 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19763
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019764capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19765 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19766 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19767 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19768
19769capture.req.method : string
19770 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19771 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19772 because it's allocated.
19773
19774capture.req.uri : string
19775 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19776 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19777 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19778 allocated.
19779
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019780capture.req.ver : string
19781 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19782 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19783 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19784
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019785capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19786 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19787 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19788 The first entry is an index of 0.
19789 See also: "capture response header"
19790
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019791capture.res.ver : string
19792 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19793 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19794 persistent flag.
19795
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019796req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019797 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19798 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19799 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019800
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019801req.body_param([<name>) : string
19802 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19803 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19804 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19805 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19806 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19807 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19808 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19809 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19810 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19811 given.
19812
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019813req.body_len : integer
19814 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19815 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019816 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19817 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019818
19819req.body_size : integer
19820 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019821 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19822 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019824req.cook([<name>]) : string
19825cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19826 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19827 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19828 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19829 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19830 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19831 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19832 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19833 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19834
19835 ACL derivatives :
19836 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19837 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19838 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19839 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19840 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19841 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19842 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19843 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019845req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19846cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19847 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19848 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019850req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19851cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19852 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19853 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19854 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19855 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019857cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19858 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19859 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19860 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19861 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019862 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019863 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19864 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19865 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19866 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019868hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19869 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19870 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19871 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19872 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019873 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019875req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019876 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19877 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19878 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19879 with headers such as User-Agent.
19880
19881 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19882 found.
19883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019884 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19885 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19886 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019887 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019889req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19890 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19891 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019892 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19893 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019895req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019896 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19897 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19898 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19899 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19900 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19901 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19902 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19903
19904 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19905 found.
19906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019907 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19908 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19909 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019910 with -1 being the last one.
19911
19912 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19913 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019915 ACL derivatives :
19916 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19917 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19918 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19919 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19920 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19921 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19922 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19923 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19924
19925req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19926hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19927 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19928 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019929 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19930 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19931 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19932
19933 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19934 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19935 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19936
19937 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019938
19939req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19940hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19941 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19942 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19943 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019944 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19945 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19946 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19947 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19948 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019949
19950 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19951
19952 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019953
19954req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19955hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19956 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19957 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19958 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019959
19960 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19961
19962 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019963
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019964req.hdrs : string
19965 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19966 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19967 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19968 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19969
19970req.hdrs_bin : binary
19971 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19972 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19973 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19974 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19975 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19976 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19977
19978 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019979
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019980 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19981 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019983http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19984 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19985 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19986 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19987 basic auth is supported.
19988
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019989http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19990 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19991 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19992 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19993 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019994 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19995 basic auth is supported.
19996
19997 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019998 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19999 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
20000 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
20001 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020002
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020003http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020004 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
20005 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20006 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020007
20008http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020009 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
20010 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20011 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020012
20013http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020014 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
20015 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
20016 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020018http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020019 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
20020 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020021 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
20022 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020024method : integer + string
20025 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
20026 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
20027 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
20028 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
20029 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
20030 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
20031 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020033 ACL derivatives :
20034 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020036 Example :
20037 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
20038 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
20039 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020041path : string
20042 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
20043 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
20044 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
20045 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
20046 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020047 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020048 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020050 ACL derivatives :
20051 path : exact string match
20052 path_beg : prefix match
20053 path_dir : subdir match
20054 path_dom : domain match
20055 path_end : suffix match
20056 path_len : length match
20057 path_reg : regex match
20058 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020059
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020020060pathq : string
20061 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
20062 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
20063 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
20064 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
20065 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
20066 result in both cases.
20067
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020068query : string
20069 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
20070 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
20071 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
20072 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020073 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020074 which stops before the question mark.
20075
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020076req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20077 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20078 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20079 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
20080 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020082req.ver : string
20083req_ver : string (deprecated)
20084 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
20085 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
20086 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020088 ACL derivatives :
20089 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020090
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020091res.body : binary
20092 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
20093 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020094 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20095
20096 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020097
20098res.body_len : integer
20099 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
20100 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020101 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20102
20103 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020104
20105res.body_size : integer
20106 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
20107 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20108 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
20109 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020110 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20111
20112 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020113
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010020114res.cache_hit : boolean
20115 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
20116 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
20117
20118res.cache_name : string
20119 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
20120 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
20121 empty string.
20122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020123res.comp : boolean
20124 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
20125 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
20126 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020128res.comp_algo : string
20129 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
20130 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
20131 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020133res.cook([<name>]) : string
20134scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20135 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20136 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020137 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20138
20139 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020141 ACL derivatives :
20142 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020144res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20145scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20146 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20147 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020148 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
20149
20150 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020152res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20153scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20154 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20155 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020156 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20157
20158 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020160res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020161 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20162 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20163
20164 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
20165 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
20166
20167 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
20168
20169 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020171res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020172 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20173 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20174
20175 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
20176 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
20177
20178 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020180res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20181shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020182 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20183 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20184
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020185 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020186 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
20187
20188 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020190 ACL derivatives :
20191 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20192 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20193 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20194 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20195 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20196 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20197 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20198 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
20199
20200res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20201shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020202 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20203 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20204
20205 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020206 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020207
20208 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020210res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20211shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020212 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
20213 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20214
20215 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20216
20217 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020218
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020219res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20220 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20221 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20222 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020223 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20224
20225 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020227res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20228shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020229 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
20230 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20231
20232 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20233
20234 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020235
20236res.hdrs : string
20237 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
20238 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20239 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020240 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20241
20242 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020243
20244res.hdrs_bin : binary
20245 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20246 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
20247 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
20248 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
20249 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
20250 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
20251 (length of 0 for both).
20252
20253 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
20254
20255 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20256 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020258res.ver : string
20259resp_ver : string (deprecated)
20260 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020261 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
20262
20263 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020265 ACL derivatives :
20266 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020268set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20269 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20270 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020271 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020272 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020274 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
20275 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020277status : integer
20278 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
20279 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020280 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
20281
20282 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020283
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020020284unique-id : string
20285 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
20286 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
20287 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
20288 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
20289 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
20290 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
20291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020292url : string
20293 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
20294 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
20295 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
20296 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
20297 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
20298 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
20299 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020301 ACL derivatives :
20302 url : exact string match
20303 url_beg : prefix match
20304 url_dir : subdir match
20305 url_dom : domain match
20306 url_end : suffix match
20307 url_len : length match
20308 url_reg : regex match
20309 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020311url_ip : ip
20312 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
20313 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
20314 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
20315 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020316 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
20317 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020319url_port : integer
20320 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020321 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020322
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020323urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
20324url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020325 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
20326 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020327 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
20328 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
20329 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
20330 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020331 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
20332 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020333 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
20334 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020336 ACL derivatives :
20337 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
20338 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
20339 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
20340 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
20341 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
20342 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
20343 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
20344 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020345
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020347 Example :
20348 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20349 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20350 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20351 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020352
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020353urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020354 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20355 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20356 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020357
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020358url32 : integer
20359 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20360 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20361 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20362 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20363 is an unsigned integer.
20364
20365url32+src : binary
20366 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20367 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20368 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20369
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020370
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200203717.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020372---------------------------------------
20373
20374This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20375used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20376purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20377There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20378or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20379any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20380for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20381
20382internal.htx.data : integer
20383 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20384 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20385
20386internal.htx.free : integer
20387 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20388 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20389
20390internal.htx.free_data : integer
20391 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20392 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20393
20394internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020395 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20396 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20397 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020398
20399internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20400 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20401 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20402
20403internal.htx.size : integer
20404 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20405 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20406
20407internal.htx.used : integer
20408 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20409 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20410 direction.
20411
20412internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20413 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20414 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20415 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20416 of the special value :
20417 * head : The oldest inserted block
20418 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020419 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020420
20421internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20422 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20423 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20424 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20425 integer or one of the special value :
20426 * head : The oldest inserted block
20427 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020428 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020429
20430internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20431 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20432 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20433 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20434 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20435
20436 * head : The oldest inserted block
20437 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020438 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020439
20440internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20441 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20442 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20443 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20444 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20445
20446 * head : The oldest inserted block
20447 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020448 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020449
20450internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20451 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20452 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20453 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20454 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20455
20456 * head : The oldest inserted block
20457 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020458 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020459
20460internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20461 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20462 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20463 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20464 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20465
20466 * head : The oldest inserted block
20467 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020468 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020469
20470internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20471 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20472 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20473 it returns false.
20474
20475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200204767.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020477---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020478
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020479Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20480every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020481order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020483ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020484---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20485FALSE always_false never match
20486HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20487HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20488HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020489HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020490HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20491HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20492HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20493HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20494LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20495METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20496METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20497METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20498METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20499METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20500METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20501METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20502METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20503RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20504REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20505TRUE always_true always match
20506WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20507---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020508
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205108. Logging
20511----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020512
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020513One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20514provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20515very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20516provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20517state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020518to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020519headers.
20520
20521In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20522about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20523send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20524
20525 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20526 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20527 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20528 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20529 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020530 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020531 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020532
20533The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20534allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20535as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20536while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20537real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20538delay.
20539
20540
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205418.1. Log levels
20542---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020543
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020544TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020545source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020546HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20547in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20548track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20549syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20550about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020551
20552
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205538.2. Log formats
20554----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020555
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020556HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020557and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20558slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20559options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020560
20561 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20562 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20563 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20564 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20565 extents.
20566
20567 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20568 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20569 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20570 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20571 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20572
20573 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20574 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20575 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20576 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20577 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20578
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020579 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20580 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20581 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20582 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20583
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020584 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20585
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020586Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20587specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20588field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20589servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20590always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20591identifier.
20592
20593Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20594 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20595 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20596 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20597 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20598
20599
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206008.2.1. Default log format
20601-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020602
20603This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20604as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20605format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20606
20607 Example :
20608 listen www
20609 mode http
20610 log global
20611 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20612
20613 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20614 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20615 (www/HTTP)
20616
20617 Field Format Extract from the example above
20618 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20619 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20620 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20621 4 'to' to
20622 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20623 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20624
20625Detailed fields description :
20626 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20627 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20628 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20629 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20630 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20631 and processed the connection.
20632 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20633
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020634In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20635"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20636connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20637
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020638It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20639will eventually disappear.
20640
20641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206428.2.2. TCP log format
20643---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020644
20645The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20646is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20647information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20648counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20649emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20650environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20651the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20652sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020653specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20654not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20655fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20656marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020657
20658 Example :
20659 frontend fnt
20660 mode tcp
20661 option tcplog
20662 log global
20663 default_backend bck
20664
20665 backend bck
20666 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20667
20668 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20669 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20670 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20671
20672 Field Format Extract from the example above
20673 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20674 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20675 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20676 4 frontend_name fnt
20677 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20678 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20679 7 bytes_read* 212
20680 8 termination_state --
20681 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20682 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20683
20684Detailed fields description :
20685 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020686 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020687 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20688 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020689 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020690 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020691 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020692
20693 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020694 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20695 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20696 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020697
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020698 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020699 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20700 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020701 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20702 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20703 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20704 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020705
20706 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20707 and processed the connection.
20708
20709 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20710 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20711 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20712 applications.
20713
20714 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20715 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20716 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20717 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20718 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20719
20720 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20721 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20722 See "Timers" below for more details.
20723
20724 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20725 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20726 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20727 "Timers" below for more details.
20728
20729 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020730 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020731 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20732 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20733 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20734 details.
20735
20736 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20737 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20738 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20739 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20740 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20741
20742 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20743 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20744 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20745 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20746 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20747 for more details.
20748
20749 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020750 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020751 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20752 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20753 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020754 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020755
20756 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20757 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20758 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20759 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20760 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20761 caused by a denial of service attack.
20762
20763 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20764 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20765 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20766 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20767 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20768 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20769 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20770 denial of service attack.
20771
20772 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20773 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20774 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20775 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20776 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20777 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20778 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20779 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20780 be processed than on other servers.
20781
20782 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20783 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20784 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20785 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020786 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020787 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20788 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20789 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20790 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20791 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20792 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20793 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20794 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20795
20796 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20797 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20798 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20799 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20800 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20801 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020802 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020803 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20804
20805 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20806 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20807 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20808 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20809 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20810 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020811 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020812 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20813 occurs.
20814
20815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208168.2.3. HTTP log format
20817----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020818
20819The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20820is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20821the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20822are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20823emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20824generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20825"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20826which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020827frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20828is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020829
20830Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20831slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20832with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20833
20834 Example :
20835 frontend http-in
20836 mode http
20837 option httplog
20838 log global
20839 default_backend bck
20840
20841 backend static
20842 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20843
20844 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20845 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20846 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020847 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020848
20849 Field Format Extract from the example above
20850 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20851 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020852 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020853 4 frontend_name http-in
20854 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020855 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020856 7 status_code 200
20857 8 bytes_read* 2750
20858 9 captured_request_cookie -
20859 10 captured_response_cookie -
20860 11 termination_state ----
20861 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20862 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20863 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20864 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20865 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020866
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020867Detailed fields description :
20868 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020869 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020870 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20871 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020872 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020873 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020874 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020875
20876 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020877 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20878 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20879 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020880
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020881 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020882 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020883
20884 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20885 and processed the connection.
20886
20887 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20888 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20889 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20890
20891 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20892 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20893 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20894 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20895 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20896 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20897
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020898 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20899 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20900 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020901 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020902 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20903 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020904 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020905 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020906
20907 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20908 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020909 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020910
20911 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20912 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020913 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20914 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020915
20916 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20917 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20918 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20919 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20920 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020921 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20922 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020923
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020924 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020925 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20926 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20927 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20928 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20929 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20930 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020931 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020932
20933 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020934 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20935 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020936
20937 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20938 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020939 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020940 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20941 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20942 overflowing.
20943
20944 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20945 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20946 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20947 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20948 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20949 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20950 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20951 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20952
20953 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20954 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20955 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20956 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20957 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20958 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20959 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20960 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20961
20962 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20963 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20964 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20965 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20966 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20967 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20968 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20969
20970 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020971 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020972 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20973 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20974 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020975 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020976 system.
20977
20978 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20979 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20980 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20981 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20982 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20983 caused by a denial of service attack.
20984
20985 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20986 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20987 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20988 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20989 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20990 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20991 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20992 denial of service attack.
20993
20994 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20995 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20996 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20997 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20998 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20999 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21000 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21001 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
21002 processed than on other servers.
21003
21004 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21005 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21006 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21007 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021008 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021009 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21010 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21011 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21012 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21013 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21014 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21015 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21016 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21017
21018 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21019 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
21020 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
21021 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
21022 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
21023 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021024 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021025 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
21026
21027 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21028 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
21029 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
21030 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
21031 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
21032 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021033 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021034 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
21035 occurs.
21036
21037 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
21038 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
21039 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
21040 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
21041 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
21042 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
21043 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
21044 cookies" below for more details.
21045
21046 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
21047 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
21048 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
21049 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
21050 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
21051 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
21052 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
21053 and cookies" below for more details.
21054
21055 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
21056 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
21057 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
21058 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
21059 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
21060 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
21061 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
21062 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
21063
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021064
210658.2.4. HTTPS log format
21066----------------------
21067
21068The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
21069extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
21070information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
21071frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
21072end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
21073matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
21074sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
21075dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
21076"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
21077
21078This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
21079appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
21080HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021081
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021082 Example :
21083 frontend https-in
21084 mode http
21085 option httpslog
21086 log global
21087 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
21088 default_backend bck
21089
21090 backend static
21091 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
21092
21093 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21094 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
21095 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
21096 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0 TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
21097
21098 Field Format Extract from the example above
21099 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21100 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
21101 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
21102 4 frontend_name https-in
21103 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
21104 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
21105 7 status_code 200
21106 8 bytes_read* 2750
21107 9 captured_request_cookie -
21108 10 captured_response_cookie -
21109 11 termination_state ----
21110 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21111 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21112 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21113 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21114 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
William Lallemandfdc3faf2021-08-02 10:57:49 +020021115 17 fc_conn_err '/' ssl_fc_hsk_err '/' ssl_c_err '/' ssl_c_ca_err 0/0/0/0
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021116 18 ssl_version '/' ssl_ciphers TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
21117
21118Detailed fields description :
William Lallemandfdc3faf2021-08-02 10:57:49 +020021119 - "fc_conn_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021120 corresponds to the "fc_conn_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_conn_err" and
21121 "fc_conn_err_str" fetches for more information.
21122
21123 - "ssl_fc_hsk_err" is the status of the SSL handshake from the frontend's
21124 point of view. It will be 0 if everything went well. See the
21125 "ssl_fc_hsk_err" sample fetch's description for more information.
21126
21127 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
21128 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
21129 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
21130 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
21131
21132 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
21133 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
21134 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
21135 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
21136
21137 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
21138
21139 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
21140
21141
211428.2.5. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021143------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021144
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021145The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021146mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021147
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021148HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021149Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
21150separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
21151prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
21152
21153Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
21154variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021155("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021156
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021157If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020021158as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021159less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
21160the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
21161
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020021162Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
21163"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
21164delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
21165preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021166
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021167Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
21168'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
21169https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
21170such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
21171
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021172Flags are :
21173 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021174 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021175 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
21176 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021177
21178 Example:
21179
21180 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
21181 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
21182
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021183 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
21184
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021185At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
21186
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021187 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21188 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021189
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021190the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021191
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021192 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
21193 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
21194 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021195
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021196the default HTTPS format is defined this way :
21197
21198 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21199 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
21200 %[fc_conn_err]/%[ssl_fc_hsk_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err] \
21201 %sslv/%sslc"
21202
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021203and the default TCP format is defined this way :
21204
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021205 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
21206 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021207
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021208Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
21209
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021210 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021211 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021212 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
21213 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
21214 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021215 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
21216 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
21217 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021218 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021219 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000021220 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000021221 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000021222 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021223 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
21224 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010021225 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020021226 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021227 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021228 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021229 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020021230 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080021231 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021232 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
21233 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
21234 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
21235 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
21236 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021237 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021238 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021239 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021240 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021241 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021242 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
21243 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021244 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21245 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
21246 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021247 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021248 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
21249 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021250 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021251 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21252 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
21253 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020021254 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020021255 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021256 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
21257 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
21258 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
21259 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020021260 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021261 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021262 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021263 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010021264 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021265 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021266 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
21267 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
21268 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021269 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021270 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
21271 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021272 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021273 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
21274 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020021275 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021276 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021277 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021278 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021279
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021280 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021281
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021282
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +0200212838.2.6. Error log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021284-----------------------
21285
21286When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +020021287protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
21288unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
21289line. In the latter case, the legacy log format described below will not be
21290used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the defined format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021291By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
21292"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021293will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +020021294logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021295
21296The format looks like this :
21297
21298 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
21299 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
21300 Connection error during SSL handshake
21301
21302 Field Format Extract from the example above
21303 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
21304 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
21305 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
21306 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
21307 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
21308
21309These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
21310failures.
21311
21312
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213138.3. Advanced logging options
21314-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021315
21316Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
21317just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
21318options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
21319for more information about their usage.
21320
21321
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213228.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
21323------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021324
21325It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021326HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021327commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
21328monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
21329ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
21330
21331 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
21332 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
21333 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
21334 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
21335
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020021336 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
21337 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021338
21339 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
21340 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
21341 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
21342
21343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213448.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
21345----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021346
21347The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
21348what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
21349or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021350"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021351just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
21352log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
21353after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
21354is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
21355with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
21356with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
21357
21358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213598.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
21360------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021361
21362Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
21363for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
21364"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
21365retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
21366raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
21367a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
21368file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
21369you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
21370"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
21371
21372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213738.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
21374--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021375
21376Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
21377multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
21378them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
21379"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
21380logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
21381error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
21382and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
21383too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
21384useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
21385alternative.
21386
21387
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213888.4. Timing events
21389------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021390
21391Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
21392reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
21393the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
21394frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021395mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
21396addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
21397
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021398Timings events in HTTP mode:
21399
21400 first request 2nd request
21401 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
21402 t tr t tr ...
21403 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
21404 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
21405 :<---- Tq ---->: :
21406 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021407 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021408 :<--------- Ta --------->:
21409
21410Timings events in TCP mode:
21411
21412 TCP session
21413 |<----------------->|
21414 t t
21415 ---|----|----|----|----|---
21416 | Th Tw Tc Td |
21417 |<------ Tt ------->|
21418
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021419 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021420 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021421 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
21422 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
21423 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021424 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021425 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
21426 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
21427 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
21428 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021429
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021430 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
21431 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
21432 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021433 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
21434 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
21435 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
21436 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
21437 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
21438 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021439
21440 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
21441 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
21442 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
21443 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
21444 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
21445 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
21446 request typed by hand during a test.
21447
21448 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
21449 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021450 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021451 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
21452 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
21453 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
21454 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021455
21456 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21457 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21458 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21459 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21460 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21461
21462 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21463 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21464 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21465 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21466 connection never established.
21467
21468 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21469 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21470 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21471 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21472 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21473 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21474 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21475 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21476 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21477 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21478 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21479
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021480 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21481 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21482 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21483 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21484 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21485 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21486
21487 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21488
21489 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21490 "Ta" can never be negative.
21491
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021492 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21493 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021494 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21495 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021496 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021497
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021498 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021499
21500 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021501 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21502 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021503
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021504 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21505 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21506 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21507 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21508 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21509 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21510 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21511 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21512
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021513These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21514protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21515that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021516due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21517"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21518that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021519
21520Most common cases :
21521
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021522 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21523 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21524 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21525 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21526 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021527 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021528 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21529 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21530 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21531 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21532 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021533 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021534
21535 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21536 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21537 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21538 of ms on remote networks.
21539
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021540 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21541 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21542 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021543
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021544 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21545 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021546 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021547 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21548 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21549 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21550 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21551 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21552 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021553
21554Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21555
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021556 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021557 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021558 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021559
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021560 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021561 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21562 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21563
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021564 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021565 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21566 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21567 flags.
21568
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021569 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21570 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021571 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21572 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21573 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21574 the client connection was maintained open.
21575
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021576 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021577 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021578 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021579 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21580
21581
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215828.5. Session state at disconnection
21583-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021584
21585TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21586"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
215872-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21588each of which has a special meaning :
21589
21590 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21591 session to terminate :
21592
21593 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21594
21595 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21596 server explicitly refused it.
21597
21598 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21599 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21600 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21601 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021602 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021603
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021604 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021605 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021606
21607 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21608 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21609 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21610 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21611 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21612
21613 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21614 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21615 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21616 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21617 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21618
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021619 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021620 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21621
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021622 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021623 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21624 backup connections when going up.
21625
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021626 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021627
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021628 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21629 send or receive data.
21630
21631 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21632 send or receive data.
21633
21634 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21635 with nothing left in the buffers.
21636
21637 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21638
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021639 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021640 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21641
21642 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21643 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21644 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21645 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21646 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21647
21648 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21649 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21650
21651 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21652 server (HTTP only).
21653
21654 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21655
21656 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21657 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21658 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21659
21660 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21661 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21662 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21663
21664 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21665
21666 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21667 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21668
21669 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21670 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21671 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21672
21673 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21674 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021675 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21676 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021677
21678 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21679 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21680 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21681 another server.
21682
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021683 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021684 server.
21685
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021686 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21687 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21688 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21689 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21690
21691 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21692 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21693 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21694 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21695
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021696 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21697 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21698 "use-server" rule).
21699
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021700 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21701
21702 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21703 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21704
21705 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21706
21707 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21708 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21709 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21710
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021711 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21712 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021713 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021714 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21715 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21716
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021717 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21718
21719 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21720 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21721
21722 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21723
21724 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21725
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021726The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21727was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021728helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21729starvation, attacks, etc...
21730
21731The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21732alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21733easier finding and understanding.
21734
21735 Flags Reason
21736
21737 -- Normal termination.
21738
21739 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021740 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21741 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021742 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21743
21744 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21745 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021746 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21747 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021748 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21749 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021750
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021751 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21752 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021753 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021754
21755 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21756 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21757 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21758
21759 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21760 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21761 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21762 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21763 the server takes too long to respond.
21764
21765 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21766 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21767 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21768 long a time to respond.
21769
21770 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21771 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21772 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021773 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021774 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21775 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021776
21777 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21778 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21779 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21780 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21781 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021782 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021783 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21784 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21785 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21786 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21787 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21788 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21789 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21790 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021791 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021792 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21793 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21794 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021795
21796 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21797 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021798 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21799 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21800 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21801 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021802
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021803 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021804 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21805
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021806 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021807 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21808 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021809 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021810 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21811 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21812
21813 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21814 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21815 503 or 504 here.
21816
21817 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021818 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021819 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21820 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21821 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21822
21823 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21824 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021825 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021826 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021827 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021828
21829 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21830 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21831 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21832 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21833 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21834 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021835 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021836
21837 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21838 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21839 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21840 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21841 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21842 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21843 solution is to fix the application.
21844
21845 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21846 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21847 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21848 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21849 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21850 external attacks.
21851
21852 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021853 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021854 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021855 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21856 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21857
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021858 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21859 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21860 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021861 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021862 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021863
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021864 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21865 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21866 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21867 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021868 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21869 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21870 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21871 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21872 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021873
21874 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21875 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21876 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21877 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21878
21879 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21880 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21881 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21882 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21883
21884 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21885 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21886 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21887 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21888
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021889The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021890persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021891important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21892re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21893
21894 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21895
21896 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21897 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21898 set on a GET request.
21899
21900 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21901 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021902 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021903 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21904
21905 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21906 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21907 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21908
21909 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21910 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21911 already got a cookie.
21912
21913 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21914 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21915 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21916 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21917 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21918
21919 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21920 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21921 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21922
21923 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21924 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21925 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21926
21927 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21928 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21929
21930 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21931 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21932 then advertised in the response.
21933
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021934
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219358.6. Non-printable characters
21936-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021937
21938In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21939consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21940converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21941prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21942being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21943escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21944is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21945'}' when logging headers.
21946
21947Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21948issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21949containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21950
21951Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21952the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21953performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21954
21955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219568.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21957---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021958
21959Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21960achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021961section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021962cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21963the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21964the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021965locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021966not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21967user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21968a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21969wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21970
21971 Examples :
21972 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21973 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21974
21975 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21976 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21977
21978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219798.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21980---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021981
21982Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21983proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21984the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21985server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21986
21987Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21988response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021989section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021990
21991It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021992time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21993appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021994are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21995and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21996follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21997request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21998in the logs.
21999
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020022000As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
22001frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
22002an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
22003
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022004 Example :
22005 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
22006 listen proxy-out
22007 mode http
22008 option httplog
22009 option logasap
22010 log global
22011 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
22012
22013 # log the name of the virtual server
22014 capture request header Host len 20
22015
22016 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
22017 capture request header Content-Length len 10
22018
22019 # log the beginning of the referrer
22020 capture request header Referer len 20
22021
22022 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
22023 capture response header Server len 20
22024
22025 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
22026 capture response header Content-Length len 10
22027
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022028 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022029 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
22030
22031 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
22032 capture response header Via len 20
22033
22034 # log the URL location during a redirection
22035 capture response header Location len 20
22036
22037 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
22038 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
22039 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22040 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
22041 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
22042
22043 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22044 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22045 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22046 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022047 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022048
22049 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22050 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22051 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22052 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
22053 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022054 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022055
22056
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220578.9. Examples of logs
22058---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022059
22060These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
22061them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
22062reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
22063
22064 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
22065 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22066 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22067
22068 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
22069 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
22070
22071 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
22072 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
22073 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22074
22075 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
22076 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
22077
22078 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
22079 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22080 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
22081
22082 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022083 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022084 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
22085 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
22086
22087 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
22088 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
22089 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
22090
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022091 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
22092 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
22093 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
22094 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022095 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022096 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022097
22098 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022099 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022100
22101 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
22102 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
22103 Nothing was sent to any server.
22104
22105 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
22106 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
22107
22108 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
22109 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022110 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022111 send a 408 return code to the client.
22112
22113 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
22114 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
22115
22116 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
22117 5 seconds ("c----").
22118
22119 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
22120 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022121 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022122
22123 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022124 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022125 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
22126 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
22127 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
22128 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
22129 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022130
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020022131
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200221329. Supported filters
22133--------------------
22134
22135Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
22136accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
22137unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
22138
22139See also : "filter"
22140
221419.1. Trace
22142----------
22143
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010022144filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022145
22146 Arguments:
22147 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
22148 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
22149
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010022150 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022151
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022152 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022153 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
22154 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
22155 amount of the parsed data.
22156
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022157 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010022158
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022159This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
22160callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
22161information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
22162filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
22163
22164Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
22165tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
22166a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
22167
22168
221699.2. HTTP compression
22170---------------------
22171
22172filter compression
22173
22174The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
22175keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022176when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
22177fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
22178done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
22179explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
22180filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
22181listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22182order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022183
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022184See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
22185 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022186
22187
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200221889.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
22189--------------------------------------------
22190
22191filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
22192
22193 Arguments :
22194
22195 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
22196 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
22197 parsed.
22198
22199 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
22200 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
22201 part must be placed in its own scope.
22202
22203The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
22204external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022205streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022206exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
22207also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
22208
22209SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
22210the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
22211
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022212For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022213"doc/SPOE.txt".
22214
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100222159.4. Cache
22216----------
22217
22218filter cache <name>
22219
22220 Arguments :
22221
22222 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
22223
22224The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
22225"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022226cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022227other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
22228case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
22229is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
22230filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010022231listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22232order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010022233
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022234See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
22235 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
22236
22237
222389.5. Fcgi-app
22239-------------
22240
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022241filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022242
22243 Arguments :
22244
22245 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
22246
22247The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
22248request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
22249reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
22250used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
22251implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
22252used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
22253fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
22254used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22255order.
22256
22257See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
22258 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
22259
22260
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100222619.6. OpenTracing
22262----------------
22263
22264The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
22265HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
22266of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
22267Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
22268
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022269This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022270
22271The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
22272HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
22273participates in the work of HAProxy.
22274
22275filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
22276
22277 Arguments :
22278
22279 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
22280 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
22281 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
22282 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
22283 OpenTracing filters.
22284
22285 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
22286 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
22287 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
22288 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
22289 filter must have its own scope defined.
22290
22291More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020022292of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022293
22294
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002229510. FastCGI applications
22296-------------------------
22297
22298HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
22299feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
22300the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
22301FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
22302servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
22303FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
22304backend.
22305
22306HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
22307application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
22308connection.
22309
2231010.1. Setup
22311-----------
22312
2231310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
22314--------------------------
22315
22316fcgi-app <name>
22317 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
22318 document root must be defined.
22319
22320acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
22321 Declare or complete an access list.
22322
22323 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
22324 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
22325 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
22326 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
22327 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
22328
22329docroot <path>
22330 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
22331 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
22332 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
22333
22334index <script-name>
22335 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
22336 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
22337 is an optional setting.
22338
22339 Example :
22340 index index.php
22341
22342log-stderr global
22343log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010022344 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022345 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
22346
22347 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
22348 default STDERR messages are ignored.
22349
22350pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22351 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
22352 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
22353 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22354
22355 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
22356 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
22357 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
22358 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
22359
22360 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
22361 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
22362
22363path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022364 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022365 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
22366 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
22367 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
22368 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
22369 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
22370 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
22371 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022372
22373 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022374 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022375 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
22376 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
22377 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
22378 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022379
22380 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022381 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
22382 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022383
22384option get-values
22385no option get-values
22386 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
22387
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022388 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022389 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
22390
22391 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
22392 application will accept.
22393
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020022394 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
22395 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022396
22397 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050022398 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022399 option is disabled.
22400
22401 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
22402 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
22403 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
22404 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
22405 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
22406 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
22407
22408option keep-conn
22409no option keep-conn
22410 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
22411 sending a response.
22412
22413 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
22414 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
22415
22416option max-reqs <reqs>
22417 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
22418 accept.
22419
22420 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
22421 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
22422 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
22423 to 1.
22424
22425option mpxs-conns
22426no option mpxs-conns
22427 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
22428
22429 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
22430 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
22431
22432set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22433 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
22434 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
22435 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
22436 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22437
22438 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
22439 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
22440 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
22441
22442 Example :
22443 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
22444 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
22445
22446 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
22447
22448
2244910.1.2. Proxy section
22450---------------------
22451
22452use-fcgi-app <name>
22453 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
22454
22455 Arguments :
22456 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22457
22458 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22459 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22460 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22461 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22462 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22463
22464 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22465 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22466 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22467 application are evaluated.
22468
22469
2247010.1.3. Example
22471---------------
22472
22473 frontend front-http
22474 mode http
22475 bind *:80
22476 bind *:
22477
22478 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22479 default_backend back-static
22480
22481 backend back-static
22482 mode http
22483 server www A.B.C.D:80
22484
22485 backend back-dynamic
22486 mode http
22487 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22488 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22489
22490 fcgi-app php-fpm
22491 log-stderr global
22492 option keep-conn
22493
22494 docroot /var/www/my-app
22495 index index.php
22496 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22497
22498
2249910.2. Default parameters
22500------------------------
22501
22502A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22503the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022504script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022505applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22506
22507 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22508 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22509 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22510 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22511 | | |
22512 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22513 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22514 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22515 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22516 | | application. |
22517 | | |
22518 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22519 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22520 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22521 | | |
22522 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22523 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22524 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22525 | | the application's configuration. |
22526 | | |
22527 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22528 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22529 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22530 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22531 | | |
22532 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22533 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22534 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22535 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22536 | | be defined. |
22537 | | |
22538 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22539 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22540 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22541 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22542 | | is not set too. |
22543 | | |
22544 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22545 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22546 | | set. |
22547 | | |
22548 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22549 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22550 | | the request. |
22551 | | |
22552 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22553 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22554 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22555 | | |
22556 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22557 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22558 | | script to process the request. |
22559 | | |
22560 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22561 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22562 | | |
22563 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22564 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22565 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22566 | | |
22567 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22568 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22569 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22570 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22571 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22572 | | |
22573 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22574 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22575 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22576 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22577 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22578 | | side. |
22579 | | |
22580 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22581 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22582 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22583 | | connected to. |
22584 | | |
22585 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22586 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22587 | | |
22588 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022589 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22590 | | current HAProxy version. |
22591 | | |
22592 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022593 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22594 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22595 | | |
22596 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22597
22598
2259910.3. Limitations
22600------------------
22601
22602The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22603way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22604during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22605establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22606application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22607or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22608message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22609these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22610and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22611
22612Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22613request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22614requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22615
22616About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22617into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22618fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22619"http-request" ones.
22620
22621Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22622FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22623processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22624must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22625here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022626
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022627
2262811. Address formats
22629-------------------
22630
22631Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22632address.
22633
22634This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22635The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22636of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22637equivalent is '::'.
22638
22639Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22640is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22641
22642This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22643family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22644
22645Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22646configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22647use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22648'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22649
22650Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22651socket type and the transport method.
22652
22653
2265411.1 Address family prefixes
22655----------------------------
22656
22657'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22658
22659'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22660 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22661 listening.
22662
22663'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22664 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22665 on the statement using this address, a port or
22666 a port range may or must be specified.
22667
22668'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22669 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22670 using this address, a port or a port range
22671 may or must be specified.
22672
22673'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22674 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22675 using this address, a port or a port range
22676 may or must be specified.
22677
22678'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22679 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22680 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22681 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22682 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22683 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22684
22685'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22686 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22687 start by slash '/'.
22688
22689
2269011.2 Socket type prefixes
22691-------------------------
22692
22693Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22694type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22695this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22696This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22697but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22698
22699Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22700instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22701
22702If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22703they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22704report this to the maintainers.
22705
22706'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22707 to "stream"
22708
22709'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22710 to "datagram".
22711
22712
2271311.3 Protocol prefixes
22714----------------------
22715
22716'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22717 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22718 socket type and transport method is forced to
22719 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22720 this address, a port or a port range can or
22721 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22722 of 'stream+ip@'.
22723
22724'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22725 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22726 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22727 statement using this address, a port or port
22728 range can or must be specified.
22729 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22730
22731'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22732 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22733 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22734 statement using this address, a port or port
22735 range can or must be specified.
22736 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22737
22738'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22739 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22740 socket type and transport method is forced to
22741 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22742 this address, a port or a port range can or
22743 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22744 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22745
22746'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22747 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22748 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22749 the statement using this address, a port or
22750 port range can or must be specified.
22751 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22752
22753'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22754 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22755 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22756 the statement using this address, a port or
22757 port range can or must be specified.
22758 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22759
22760'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22761 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22762 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22763
22764'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22765 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22766 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22767
22768In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22769QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22770
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022771/*
22772 * Local variables:
22773 * fill-column: 79
22774 * End:
22775 */